45PLCTSXPL7
45PLCTSXPL7
01-04
Catalogue
January
04
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
General contents
2- Discrete I/O
Selection guide I/O modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 2/2
b 2.1 - Discrete I/O modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 2/6
b 2.1 - Safety module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 2/18
b 2.1 - Extension module for Nano PLCs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 2/24
Selection guide Telefast 2 pre-wired system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 2/26
b 2.2 - Telefast 2 pre-wired system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 2/32
b 2.2 - Tego installation system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 2/44
Selection guide Phaseo power supplies for DC control circuits . . . . page 2/50
b 2.3 - Phaseo power supplies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 2/52
3 - Application-specific modules
Selection guide analogue I/O . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 3/2
b 3.1 - Integrated channels and analogue I/O modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 3/4
b 3.1 - Process control of semi-continuous processes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 3/10
Selection guide counter/positionning modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 3/14
b 3.2 - Integrated channels and counter/positioning modules . . . . . . . . . page 3/16
b 3.2 - Absolute encoder positioning module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 3/22
4 - Communication
Selection guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4/2
b 4.1 - Ethernet TCP/IP network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4/6
b 4.2 - CANopen machine bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4/22
b 4.2 - AS-Interface sensors/actuators bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4/26
b 4.3 - Modbus Plus network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4/34
b 4.3 - Modbus bus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4/38
b 4.4 - Fipway network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4/46
b 4.4 - Fipio bus Agent function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4/50
b 4.4 - Uni-Telway bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4/60
b 4.4 - Asynchronous serial links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4/64
6 - Services
b Documentation and power consumption of TSX Micro PLC modules . . . page 6/2
b Standards, certifications and community regulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 6/6
b Schneider Electric worldwide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 6/10
b Product references index. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 6/16
3
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
SS301-EN_Ver1.0.fm/0
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Contents
SS301-EN_Ver1.0.fm/1
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection guide
Applications
No. of slots
Base
Extension
92
60 (28 I/O)
120
88 (56 I/O)
Counting
Communication
2 half-format modules (1, 2 x 40 kHz channels, 2 x 500 kHz channels, 1 x 1 MHz SSI channel)
1 x integrated RS 485 channel (TER port)
AS-Interface master
Fipio agent function
CANopen master
1 TER port
Ethernet TCP/IP
Nertwork cards
Network connections
Process control
Control loops, 3 integrated functions : PID, PWM (pulse width modulation) et SERVO (discrete valve
Real-time clock
11 Kwords
14 Kwords
Memory capacity
Integrated RAM
Extension (2)
Data storage
Power supply
Type of PLCs
TSX 37 05 028DR1
Pages
1/15
TSX 37 08 056DR1
TSX 37 10 028pR1
(1) The value in bracket and in italics corresponds to number of I/O providing with the basic PLC configuration.
(2) For program and constants zones.
1/2
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
module)
248
160
module connecting to 4 Nano componants (PLC base or discrete/analogue extension, 200 m max.)
control) with MMI on CCX 17 operator panel (control and adjustment of 9 loops maximum)
20 Kwords
128 Kwords
128 Kwords
c 24 V non-isolated
TSX 37 10 128Dp1
TSX 37 10
1ppDTK1
TSX 37 21 101
c 24 V non-isolated
TSX 37 21 001
TSX 37 22 101
TSX 37 22 001
1/3
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description,
selection
TSX 37 05 PLCs
Presentation
The TSX 37 05 PLC comprises a rack which integrates a 100/240 V power supply,
a processor including a 11 Kword memory (program, data and constants), 1 Flash
EPROM backup memory, a TSX DMZ 28DR discrete I/O module (16 inputs and
12 relay outputs) and an available slot.
The available slot can accept:
b 1 standard format discrete I/O module of any type.
b 2 half format discrete I/O, safety, analog I/O or counter modules.
Description
The TSX 37 05 PLC comprises:
2
1 2-slot rack.
2 Centralized display block.
3 Terminal port (TER) (Uni-Telway master/slave, Modbus RTU slave protocol or
characters string).
4 Cover for accessing the power supply terminals.
5 Discrete module with 16 inputs and 12 outputs, placed in the first slot (positions
1 and 2). Including screw terminal block.
6 Cover for accessing optional battery.
8 6
7 Available slot.
8 Reset button.
Selection
Selection of modules to be inserted in addition to the 16-input/12-output module present at rack no. 1
Type of module to be inserted
Discrete Inputs/Outputs
Counter/positioning channels
Format
Standard
Half
Connection
Connector
Term.blk
8 inputs
12 inputs
32 inputs
4 outputs
8 outputs
32 outputs
16 inputs/outputs
28 inputs/outputs
64 inputs/outputs
4 or 8 inputs
2 or 4 outputs
4 inputs and 2 outputs
1 incremental code
channel
2 incremental code
channels
1 absolute encoder
channel
Possible insertion
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/4
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description,
selection (continued)
TSX 37 08 PLCs
Presentation
The TSX 37 08 PLC comprises a rack which integrates a 100/240 V power supply,
a processor including a 11 Kword memory (program, data and constants), 1 Flash
EPROM backup memory, 2 TSX DMZ 28DR discrete I/O modules (16 inputs and
12 relay outputs) and an available slot.
The available slot can accept:
b 1 standard format discrete I/O module of any type.
b 2 half format discrete I/O, safety, analog I/O or counter modules.
Description
2
1 3-slot rack.
2 Centralized display block.
3 Terminal port (TER) (Uni-Telway master/slave, Modbus RTU slave protocol or
characters string).
4 Cover for accessing the power supply terminals.
5 Two discrete modules with 16 inputs and 12 outputs, placed in the first and second
slot (positions 1 to 4). Including screw terminal block.
6 Cover for accessing optional battery.
4
7 Available slot.
8 Reset button.
Selection
Selection of modules to be inserted in addition to the 16-input/12-output module present at rack no. 1
Type of module to be inserted
Discrete Inputs/Outputs
Counter/positioning channels
Format
Standard
Half
Connection
Connector
Term.blk
8 inputs
12 inputs
32 inputs
4 outputs
8 outputs
32 outputs
16 inputs/outputs
28 inputs/outputs
64 inputs/outputs
4 or 8 inputs
2 or 4 outputs
4 inputs and 2 outputs
1 incremental code
channel
2 incremental code
channels
1 absolute encoder
channel
Possible insertion
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/5
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description,
selection (continued)
TSX 37 10 PLCs
Presentation
Compact and modular TSX 37 10 PLCs differ in their supply voltage and the type of
discrete I/O module fitted in the first slot.
Each TSX 37 10 configuration comprises a rack which integrates a power supply
(c 24 V or a 100/240 V), a processor including a 14 Kword RAM memory (program,
data and constants), a Flash EPROM backup memory, a real-time clock, a discrete
I/O module (28 or 64 I/O) and an available slot. A TSX RKZ 02 mini extension rack
enables the number of slots to be increased by 2 (4 positions).
Each available slot can accept:
b 1 standard format discrete I/O module of any type.
b 2 half format discrete I/O, safety, analog I/O or counter modules.
Also, TSX 37 10 PLCs can connect to the Ethernet network TCP/IP or to a Modem
via the TSX ETZ 410/510 external stand-alone module.
Description
2
12 6
11
10 9
TSX 37 10 PLCs and the TSX RKZ 02 mini extension rack comprise:
1 2-slot base rack.
2 Centralized display block.
3 Terminal port (TER) (Uni-Telway, Modbus RTU master/slave protocol or
characters string).
4 Cover for accessing the power supply terminals.
5 28 or 64 discrete I/O module, placed in the first slot (positions 1 and 2).
6 Cover for accessing optional battery.
7 Mini extension rack with 2 available slots -(positions 5 to 8).
8 LED showing presence of c 24 V.
9 Power supply terminals protected by removable cover, to connect an auxiliary
c 24 V power supply if PLCs are supplied with a 100/240 V.
10 Earth terminal.
11 Connectors to the base PLC.
12 Reset button.
Selection
TSX 37 10 base PLC selection
Power supply
c 24 V
a 110/240V
32
16
16
Connection
HE 10
Connector
Number of outputs
Solid state c
Relay
24 V
12
12
12
32
12
12
Reference
Screw terminal
block
TSX 37 10 128DT1
TSX 37 10 128DTK1
TSX 37 10 128DR1
TSX 37 10 164DTK1
TSX 37 10 028AR1
TSX 37 10 028DR1
8 inputs
12 inputs
32 inputs
4 outputs
8 outputs
32 outputs
16 inputs/outputs
28 inputs/outputs
64 inputs/outputs
Format
Stand.
Half
Connection
Connect. Term.blk
(2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
(3)
External module
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/6
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description,
selection (continued)
Presentation
Modular TSX 37 21/22 PLCs differ in their supply voltage and/or the possibility of fast
counting and analogue functions integrated on the base.
Each PLC comprises: a 3-slot rack which integrates a power supply (c 24 V or
a 100/240 V), a processor including a 20 Kword RAM memory (program, data
and constants), 1 Flash EPROM backup memory, 2 slots for a PCMCIA card
(1 communication card and 1 memory extension card of 128 Kwords maximum) and
a real-time clock. A TSX RKZ 02 mini extension rack enables the number of slots
to be increased by 2 (4 positions).
Each available slot can accept:
b 1 standard format discrete I/O module.
b 2 half format discrete I/O, safety, analog I/O or counter modules.
Also, TSX 37 21/22 PLCs can connect to the Ethernet network TCP/IP or to a modem
via the TSX ETZ 410/510 external stand-alone module.
Description
TSX 37 21/22 PLCs and the TSX RKZ 02 mini extension rack comprise:
9
5 2
10
14
6
8 15
Selection
Selection of modules to be inserted (5 slots available, that is a maximum of 9 positions)
Type of module to be inserted
Discrete Inputs/
Outputs
8 inputs
12 inputs
32 inputs
4 outputs
8 outputs
32 outputs
16 inputs/outputs
28 inputs/outputs
64 inputs/outputs
Preventa safety module
AS-Interface bus or I/O extension
Analog I/O
4 or 8 inputs
2 or 4 outputs
2 inputs and 4 outputs
Counting/
1 or 2 incremental encoder channels
positioning
1 absolute encoder channel
Communication Serial link
(PCMCIA card on CANopen bus
processor)
Modbus bus
Fipio Agent bus
Uni-Telway bus
Modbus Plus network
Fipway network
Communication Ethernet TCP/IP or external Modem
9
(3)
(2)
Format
Stand.
Half
Connection
Connect. Term.blk
(2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(4)
External module
Possible insertion
(1) With TSX RKZ 02 mini extension rack.
(2) Comprises a standard format module to be placed in 1st slot of the PLC.
(3) The remote discrete I/O extension modules and AS-interface bus modules are installed in
position 4 which means that their use is mutually exclusive.
(4) With a maximum of 2 (TSX AMZ 600/ASZ 200) modules in the base.
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/7
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions
Functions
Discrete inputs/outputs
The range of in-rack discrete I/O modules offers several possibilities for meeting
requirements:
b Cost-effective connection where a c 24 V solution is required (mixed I/O modules
with HE type 10 connectors for direct connection to pre-actuators in the device using
cables with flying leads or direct connection to the TELEFAST2 pre-wired system).
b Connection to the screw terminal block on the front panel of mixed I/O modules.
A set of half format modules enable the PLC configuration to be adapted as closely
as possible to the user's requirements in terms of number, range of I/O and type of
connection.
For further details, see pages 2/6 to 2/17.
The TSX DPZ 10D2A Preventa type safety relay module provides a monitoring
function for the emergency stop pushbuttons or limit switches, and is adapted to
conform to the safety requirements stipulated in EN 954-1.
For further details, see pages 2/18 to 2/23.
b The AS-Interface sensor/actuator bus. TSX Micro PLCs are connected to the
AS-Interface bus via an AS-Interface master module. In this case, the PLC becomes
the master station on the bus and manages a maximum of 248 I/O over a distance
of up to 100 m (200 m with a repeater).
For further details, see pages 4/26 to 4/29.
b The CANopen machine bus. The communication of the Micro TSX 37 21/22 PLCs
enables the connectivity to the CANopen machine bus. It is appeared as a PCMCIA
card equipped with a cable (length 0.5m) and a tap junction (with 9-way SUB-D
connector). This TSX CPP 110 kit allows the direct linking to the bus and ensures the
role of the master on the CANopen bus. The PCMCIA card is inserted into the
reserved slot for communication card, available on the TSX 37 21 and TSX 37 22.
For further details, see pages 4/22 to 4/25.
TSX Micro PLCs have, as standard, process control functions which can be
accessed by the user via the PL7 Micro, PL7 Junior or PL7 Pro programming
software.
For further details, see pages 3/10 to 3/13.
Description:
pages 1/4 to 1/7
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/8
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions (continued)
Counting/positioning
Counter modules TSX Micro PLCs offer several ways of counting:
Communication
TSX Micro PLCs offer several possibilities:
b Integrated communication which offers cost-effective dialogue functions via the
terminal port for TSX 37 05/08/10 PLCs or via the terminal and man-machine
interface ports for TSX 37 21/22 PLCs. These RS 485 type non-isolated links use
Uni-Telway master/slave, Modbus RTU slave or character string.
Also TSX 37 10/21/22 PLCs integrate Modbus master protocol.
b PCMCIA format communication card for TSX 37 21/22 PLCS. They have a
dedicated slot for the PCMCIA format communication card ("Full-duplex"
asynchronous serial link, CANopen bus, Fipio bus, Uni-Telway or Modbus, Modbus
Plus or Fipway network).
b Ethernet TCP/IP 10/100 MHz external modules. This external module connects to
the terminal port of TSX 37 10/21/22 PLCs and has Uni-TE and Modbus messaging.
It also allows connection to an external modem using PPP protocol.
For further details, see pages 4/6 to 4/21.
Fan modules
TSX FAN ppP fan modules installed above TSX Micro PLCs ensure a forced air
convection, which creates a uniform ambient temperature within the enclosure and
eliminates any hot spots which might exist.
Fan modules are required when the ambient temperature is between 60 C and
70 C. Forced ventilation is used to eliminate hot spots (1).
Three types of fan module are available: c 24 V, a 110 V and a 220 V.
One fan module is required for a TSX 37 05/08/10/21/22 configuration, two fan
modules are required for a TSX 37 10/21/22 configuration with the TSX RKZ 02
mini rack.
TSX 37 05/08/10
TSX 37 08/21/22
Description:
pages 1/4 to 1/7
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
(1) For an ambient temperature of between 25 C60 C, the use of fan modules increases the
MBTF.
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/9
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Memory structure
Memory structure
The memory structure of TSX Micro PLCs consists of two distinct zones:
b An internal RAM memory designed to receive the application (data, program and
constants) of
v 11 Kwords for TSX 37 05/08 PLCs,
v 14 Kwords for the TSX 37 10 PLC,
v 20 Kwords for TSX 37 21/22 PLCs.
b A Flash EPROM memory of:
v 12 Kwords for TSX 37 05/08 PLCs,
v 16 Kwords for TSX 37 10/21/22 PLCs
designed to back up the application program (11 or 14 Kwords maximum) and to
back up 1024 %MW internal words in the event of a battery failure or no battery.
For TSX 37 21/22 PLCs, the internal RAM memory can be extended via a 32, 64 or
128 Kwords PCMCIA memory card, either RAM or Flash EPROM. The same
memory card incorporated the possibility of contained a storage zone for additional
data, e.g. for production data and manufacturing recipes.
PCMCIA memory extension cards for TSX 37 21/22 PLCs
These cards can be used to extend the PLC internal memory for storing the
application program and constants.
Two types of memory card are available:
b Battery-backed RAM type memory card
Used in particular during application program creation and debugging, this card
enables all application transfer and modification services in online mode.
The memory is backed up by a removable battery integrated in the memory card.
b Flash EPROM type memory card
Used when the debugging of the application program is complete, this card enables
one global transfer only of the application and avoids the problems of backup via
battery.
A third type of card can also be used to store additional data:
b Battery-backed RAM type memory card or battery-backed RAM and Flash
EPROM
Used particularly in association with the Modem link, these are used to extend the
processor's internal memory, and also to store recipe or data log for later consultation
via a telephone link.
The RAM memory is backed up by a removable battery integrated in the
memory card.
Another type of PCMCIA memory card is available:
b Backup type memory card (for TSX 37 21/22 PLCs)
Previously loaded with the application program, this card is used to reload the
application program into the internal RAM memory and the internal Flash EPROM
memory of the processor, without requiring the use of a programming terminal.
Program loader
The TSX PRG LDR module is designed to simplify duplicating or updating
applications on Nano and TSX Micro PLCs without the need for a programming
terminal. An application (15 Kwords maximum in internal RAM) can be transferred
from a PLC in the TSX PRG LDR module (and saved within it), then transferred from
the TSX PRG LDR module to the PLC.
2
3
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/10
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
automation platform
Application memory
The application memory is divided into memory zones, which are physically shared
between the internal RAM memory and the PCMCIA memory card (if the TSX 37 21/
22 PLC has a memory card):
b The application data zone which is always is the internal RAM memory.
b The application program zone in the internal RAM memory or on the PCMCIA
memory card.
b The constants zone in the internal RAM memory or on the PCMCIA memory card.
b The Flash EPROM zone for the application program backup, the constants and
1 K internal words.
b The file storage zone in the PCMCIA memory card.
If the content of the RAM memory is lost (battery fault or no battery) then the content
of the Flash EPROM memory (program, constants and 1 K internal words) is
automatically transferred to the internal RAM memory. The backup copy of the
application in the Flash EPROM memory requires that the PLC does not have a
PCMCIA memory extension card and that the size of the program and the constants
does not exceed 16 Kwords.
Two types of application memory organization are possible for TSX Micro PLCs
depending on whether the PLC is equipped with a memory extension in the form of a
PCMCIA card:
TSX 37 05/08/10/21/22 (without PCMCIA card)
Backup copy
Flash
EPROM
11/14/20
Kwords
Internal
RAM
Program
12/16
Kwords
Data
Constants
Backup copy
Flash
EPROM
PCMCIA
card
1
2
3
4
128 32/64/128
16
Kwords Kwords Kwords
Internal
RAM
20
Kwords
b 11 Kwords for TSX 37 05/08, shared, for example: as 3 Kwords of application data
and 8 Kwords of the program and its constants.
b 14 Kwords for TSX 37 10, shared, for example: as 500 words of application data
and 13.5 Kwords of the program and its constants.
b 20 Kwords for TSX 37 21/22, shared, for example: as 4 Kwords of application data
and 16 Kwords of the program and its constants.
Application in the internal Flash EPROM
The total volume is equal to the application volume in RAM, limited to 11 Kwords
or 15 Kwords, to which the backup of the first 1024 data words (%MW) is added.
Application in the PCMCIA card
The PCMCIA memory card contains the program and the constants.
The additional data storage zone for 128 Kword data (available according to the
PCMCIA card model) can be used for distributed applications, for storing information
which can be consulted remotely via Modem.
This zone can also be used for storing manufacturing recipes.
Internal RAM data
The data zone can be extended to 20 Kwords, and is only held in the PLC
internal RAM.
Data backup
The first 1024 words are backed up by the PLC internal Flash EPROM memory.
PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro software aids the application designer in the management
of the structure and the occupation of memory space for TSX Micro PLCs.
Application protection
Whatever the PLC's memory structure is: application in internal RAM or on the
PCMCIA card, it is possible to protect the structure to prohibit access (reading or
program modification) in online mode using PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro software.
Backup application
Micro TSX 37 21/22 PLCs make it possible to save the 32 Kwords maximum
application (programs and constants) on a Backup TSX MFP BAK 032P memory
card. The internal RAM memory can thus be reloaded with the contents of this
Backup memory card.
This Backup function is not available if the application runs on a PCMCIA RAM or
Flash EPROM memory card.
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/11
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Centralized display,
description
Centralized display
TSX Micro PLCs are equipped with a display block which groups together centrally
all the data required for the control, diagnostics and maintenance of the PLC and all
its modules, as well as simple man-machine interface functions.
The centralized display provides:
b Display of the local or remote I/O channel states
(I/O of Nano PLCs).
b Display of devices on the AS-Interface bus and AS-Interface bus diagnostics (see
page 4/26).
b Display of diagnostics of faulty channels or modules.
b Display of internal data:
v bits,
v bit strings,
v word strings,
v program variables (active steps, application information, etc).
b 4-digit multiple digital display.
Description
The centralized display block comprises:
BASE
EXT
64 16
R I/O
64 16
WRD
1 Three blocks of 32 LEDs representing the slots in which the modules are installed
in the base rack or mini extension rack.
RUN
8 12
8 12
8 12
9 13
9 13
9 13
6 10 14
6 10 14
6 10 14
7 11 15
7 11 15
7 11 15
8 12
8 12
8 12
9 13
9 13
9 13
6 10 14
6 10 14
6 10 14
7 11 15
7 11 15
7 11 15
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
DIAG
64 16
2 An information line consisting of LEDs which show the display operating modes.
TER
> 1s.
DIAG
I/O
ERR
BAT
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
3 A command push button which provides access to the various display operating
modes.
4
v
v
v
v
v
Five LEDs:
RUN, PLC run/stop,
TER, traffic on the terminal port,
I/O, I/O fault,
ERR, processor or application fault,
BAT, battery fault or no battery.
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/12
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
Characteristics
TSX Micro PLCs have been developed to conform to the national and international
standards concerning electronic devices for industrial control systems:
b Specific requirements for programmable controllers: functional characteristics,
resistance, robustness, safety, etc. IEC 61131-2, CSA 22-2, UL 508.
b Merchant navy requirements from the main European bodies: BV, DNV, GL,
GOST, LR, RRS.
b European directives (low voltage, electromagnetic compatibility), e marking.
b Electrical qualities and self-extinguishing capacity of insulating materials:
UL 746C, UL 94, etc. See page 6/4.
Relative
humidity
Operation
0...+ 60 (+ 5...+ 55 conforming to IEC 61131-2), 0+ 70 with TSX FAN ventilation modules
Storage
Operation
Storage
Altitude
Mechanical
withstand
02000
Resistant to vibrations
Resistant to shocks
Resistant to
Withstand to electrostatic discharge
electrostatic
discharge
Resistance to HF Resistant to electromagnetic fields
interference
Resistant to rapid transient bursts
Power supply a
a 100...240
Power supply c
c 24
a 90264
Frequency
Limit (including
ripple)
Nominal (limit)
Hz
50-60 (47-63)
c 19.2...30V
possible up to 34 V for 1 hr per 24 hrs
Current
Nominal input
Inrush (2)
y 60
y 60
y 10 ms, repetition u 1 s
Secondary
Micro-breaks
Accepted duration
Power
Total useful
(typical)
c 5 V output
24 (32 peak)
16 (18 peak)
Output c 24 VR
(for relay outputs)
c 24 V output
sensors
Overloads
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
2000 - 50/60 Hz
Output currents
Protection
integrated on the
outputs against
Short-circuits
Isolation
Dielectric
resistance
Primary/
secondary
V rms
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/13
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics (continued)
Processor chracteristics
Type of PLc
No. of slots
Functions
(Max.no.)
TSX 37 05
2
60 (28 I/O)
92
Basic
With extension rack, 2 slots
Discrete I/
Screw terminal block
O(1)
HE10 connector
64 channel modules
Integrated
Modules
Type of modules
Regulation
Counting
Integrated
channels (2) Modules
Type of modules
Discrete I/O
Integrated
Serial link
connections
Type of links
Networks
Ethernet TCP/IP
and bus
Fipway network,
connections Modbus Plus
AS-Interface bus
CANopen bus
Modbus bus,
Uni-Telway,
Characters string
Extension by Nano base and Nano
extension (200 m maxi)
88 (56 I/O)
120
TSX 37 10
2
4
124 (28 I/O)
184 (28 or 64 I/
O)
2
TSX 37 21
3
5
160 ()
248 ()
TSX 37 22
1
3
8 I et 1 O
2
4
Half format module 4 or 8 I, 2 or 4 O, 4 I/O
The number of loops is limited by the number of analogue modules and by the size of memory
2 channel 10 kHz
2
2 (3)
4 (3)
Half format module 1 or 2 channel 40/500 kHz, 1 channel SSI 1 MHz
2 channels 500 Hz
1 link with 1connector (TER) 19.2 Kbit/s
1 link with 2 connectors (TER and
AUX) 19,2 Kbit/s
Uni-Telway master/slave
Modbus slave RTU
Modbus master/slave RTU
Character mode
Character mode
1 (4)
Analog I/O
TSX 37 08
3
Kwords 11
Kwords
Kwords
bits
Kwords
Words
14
20
128 with PCMCIA card
128
s
s
256
1 (6)
128 (6)
1
1
8
0,25
4,81
s
s
0,19
4,50
Kinst/
ms
Kinst/
ms
Kinst/
ms
Kinst/
ms
ms
3,03
5,88
0,25
0,27
4,00
0,266
1,9
1,6
2,3
(1) The value in bracket and in italics corresponds to number of I/O providing with the basic PLC
configuration.
(2) Maximum number of couting/positioning channels, see page 3/16.
(3) TSX CTZpp counting/positioning modules, only in the TSX Micro base.
(4) PCMCIA to insert in the communication card slot
(5) The remote discrete I/O extension modules and AS-Interface bus modules are installed in
position 4 which means that their use is mutually exclusive.
(6) Default size, can be extended, but will have an adverse effect on the size of the application
program.
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/14
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Integrated memories
RAM
a 100240 V
11 Kwords
Flash
EPROM
12 Kwords
Weight
TSX 37 05 028DR1
kg
2.370
TSX 37 08 056DR1
2.720
Integrated memories
RAM
c 24 V
14 Kwords
Flash
EPROM
15 Kwords
a 100240 V
TSX 37 10 164DTK1
14 Kwords
15 Kwords
Weight
TSX 37 10 128DT1
kg
1.870
1 module with
16 I c 24 V
12 O relay
TSX 37 10 128DR1
1.900
Via screw
terminal block
(supplied)
1.740
1.820
1 module with
16 I a 115 V
12 O relay
Via screw
terminal block
(supplied)
TSX 37 10 028AR1
1.910
1 module with
16 I c 24 V
12 O relay
Via screw
terminal block
(supplied)
TSX 37 10 028DR1
1.910
c 24 V
a 100240 V
Integrated memories
RAM
Flash
EPROM
20 Kwords
5 Kwords
Integrated functions
Reference
TSX 37 21 101
kg
1.720
TSX 37 22 101
1.750
TSX 37 21 001
1.720
TSX 37 22 001
1.750
Use
Number maximum
Reference
TSX RKZ 02
20 Kwords
15 Kwords
TSX 37 22 p01
Weight
Weight
kg
0.630
Documentation
TSX Micro base and module installation manual
TSX RKZ 02
Description:
pages /4 to 41/7
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/15
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References (continued)
References
(continued)
Use
TSX 37 21/22
Memory size
Application
32 Kwords
Reference
Data storage
128 Kwords
128 Kwords
128 Kwords
64 Kwords
TSX MRP pppP
128 Kwords
Weight
kg
0.060
0.060
0.060
0.060
0.060
0.060
Memory size
Application
32 Kwords
Reference
Data storage
128 Kwords
128 Kwords
64 Kwords
128 Kwords
Weight
kg
0.060
0.060
0.060
0.060
0.060
Memory size
Application
TSX 37 05/08/ 32 Kwords
10
Reference
Data storage
Reference
Weight
kg
0.060
Fan modules
Description
Quantity to be used
Supply
Fan modules
(2)
c 24 V
TSX FAN D2P
a 100120 V TSX FAN A4P
a 200240 V TSX FAN A5P
Weight
kg
0.500
0.500
0.500
Separate parts
Description
Use
Program
loader with
terminal port
conn. cable
Connection
accessories
Discrete I/O
Discrete I/O with Telefast 2
0.030
0.320
0.010
TSX RAZ 01
0.010
TSX P CAP
0.030
Backup
batteries
Cover for
empty slot
Gripper
Quantity
Pack of 10
Unity reference
Weight
kg
0.150
Description:
pages /4 to 41/7
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
Dimensions, mounting:
page 1/17
1/16
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Dimensions,
mounting
Dimensions, mounting
Front view
Mounting
108,3 (1)
140
17
AF1-AE4
132,5 (2)
(4)
G
H
152 (3)
TSX 37
a
05 028DR1
170.3
08 056DR1
227.9
10 028/128/164pp1
170.3
21/22 p01
227.9
(1) Empty PLC
(2) With screw terminal block
(3) With HE 10 type or SUB-D connectors
(4) Fixing holes for M4 screws
5,5
151
151
5,5
Side view
282.7
341.4
19
19
TSX 37
05 028DR1
08 056DR1
10 028/128/164pp1
21/22 p01
G
159.2
198.9
159.2
198.9
271.7
311.4
J
5
24
5
24
32,5
58
54
110
138
140
146
150
Installation regulations
100
(1)
(3)
100
150
(1)
(1)
(3)
(1)
150
(1)
(1)
(2)
(1) u 50 mm
(2) Switch gear or enclosure
(3) Cable ducting or wiring clip
Description:
pages 1/2 to 1/7
Functions:
pages 1/8 and 1/9
Characteristics:
pages 1/13 and 1/14
References:
pages 1/15 and 1/16
1/17
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
2/0
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Contents
2 - Discrete I/O
2/1
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection guide
I/O connection on screw terminal block: via bare wires, via wires fitted with cable ends, or wires fitted with
Type
Nature
32 inputs
Inputs c 24 V
Connection
2
2.1
32 outputs
Outputs c 24 V solid state
0.5 A
Possible association
with Tego systems
Tego Dial
Tego Power
Isolated inputs
Control
Type 2
Positive
c 2-wire, c/a 2-wire,
c 3-wire PNP
Isolated outputs
Control
Pages
2/13
Preactuator voltage
monitoring
Configurable fallback of
outputs
Yes
Protected
Positive
Non-protected
2/2
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
2
2.1
16 inputs/12 outputs
Inputs c 24 V
Relay outputs 3 A (lth)
Inputs a 100120 V
Relay outputs 3 A (lth)
32 inputs/32 outputs
Inputs c 24 V
Outputs c 24 V/0.1 A
Inputs c 24 V
Outputs c 24 V/0.5 A
Type 2
Type 1
Positive
c 2-wire,
c 3-wire PNP
Preactuator voltage monitoring
Configurable fallback of outputs
Yes
Protected
Positive
2/3
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
I/O connection on screw terminal block: via bare wires, via wires fitted with cable ends, or wires fitted with
maximum 1.5 mm2.
Type
Nature
12 inputs
Inputs c 24 V
Connection
2
2.1
Possible association
with Telefast 2
8 inputs
Inputs
a 100120 V
Inputs
a 200240 V
8 outputs
Outputs
c/a relay 3 A (lth)
Connection sub-base
I/O adaptor sub-base
Possible association
with Tego systems
Tego Dial
Tego Power
Isolated inputs
Control
EC 1131-2 conformity
Logic
Prox.sens.compat. conforming
to standard IEC 947-5-2
Isolated outputs
c 2-wire
c/a 2-wire,
c 3-wire PNP/NPN
a 2-wire
Type 1
a 2-wire
Control
Configurable
fallback of outputs
Non-protected
Type of modules
TSX
DEZ 12D2
Pages
2/13
TSX
DEZ 08A4
TSX
DEZ 08A5
TSX
DSZ 08R5
2/4
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
I/O connection on HE 10 connector: with preformed cables with flying leads (cross-section
0.324 mm2) ribbon cables (cross-section 0.08 mm2) or connection cables (cross-section
0.324 mm2).
2
2.1
4 outputs
Outputs c 24 V/2 A
8 outputs
Outputs c 24 V/0.5 A
12 inputs
Inputs c 24 V
8 inputs/8 outputs
Inputs c 24 V
Outputs c 24 V/0.5 A
Type 1
c 2-wire,
c 3-wire PNP
Preactuator voltage
monitoring. Configurable
fallback of outputs
Yes
Protected
Positive
Yes
Protected
Positive
2/5
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connection principles
Connection principles
Connecting modules with screw terminal blocks
The screw connection terminal blocks are fitted with a removable cover ensuring:
b The screws are held in place
b Personnel safety
Each terminal on a screw terminal block can accept bare wires or wires fitted with
cable ends, with closed or open tags. The capacity of each terminal is:
b Minimum:
v 1 wire 0.28 mm2 (AWG 23) without cable end
b Maximum:
v 2 wires 1 mm 2 (AWG 17) with cable end, or
v 1 wire 1.5 mm2 (AWG 15) without cable end, or
v 1 open or closed tag for wires of 1 mm2 (AWG 17).
2
2.1
Used for the simple and direct wire to wire connection of the
I/O of modules with connectors 1 to the sensors, preactuators or terminals.
The prewired cable 3 comprises:
At one end, a moulded HE 10 type connector 2 with 20 x 0.34 mm2 cross-section
wires in a sheath.
At the other end 4, flying leads -differentiated by colour coding conforming to DIN
47100.
4
6
2
Characteristics:
pages 2/9 to 2/12
References:
pages 2/13 and 2/14
Connections :
Connections:
pages 2/15 to 2/17
2/6
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connection principles
(continued),
description
2
2.1
Description
Discrete I/O modules connected via screw terminal block
Half-format or standard format I/O modules with connection via screw terminal block
comprise:
1
2
3
4
Half-format or standard format I/O module
1
2
2
3
Characteristics:
pages 2/9 to 2/12
References :
References:
pages 2/13 and 2/14
Connections:
pages 2/15 to 2/17
2/7
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions,
compatibility
Functions
I/O assignment
By software configuration, specific functions can be assigned to certain inputs. The
first four inputs of a discrete I/O module located in slot 1 of a TSX Micro PLC can be
configured as discrete inputs, latching inputs, event-triggered inputs or up/down
counter inputs.
Inputs which can be configured as latching inputs
These are inputs %I1.0 to %I1.3. The principle is that, on a pulse which is shorter
than the PLC scan, the pulse is stored and processed on the next PLC scan. The
pulse is taken into account when the input changes state (rising and/or falling edge
depending on the selected configuration).
2.1
Types of inputs
c 24 V
Type 1
Positive logic
c 24 V
Type 2
Positive logic
c 24 V
a 100120 V
Type 2
a 200240 V
Type 1
Negative logic
(1)
(1)
Compatible
(1) In the nominal voltage range a 220240 V.
Characteristics:
pages 2/9 to 2/12
References :
References:
pages 2/13 and 2/14
Connections:
pages 2/15 to 2/17
2/8
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
Nominal input
values
Voltage
Current
Sensor supply (ripple included)
Input limit values At state1
Voltage
Current
At state 0
Voltage
Current
Input impedance at state 1
Configurable
State 0 to 1
response time
State 1 to 0
IEC 1131-2 conformity
Proximity sensor compatibility 2/3-wire
Isolation resistance
Type of input
Consumption
Dissipated power
mA
Isolation
V rms
V rms
V
mA
V
mA
K
ms
ms
Type of modules
Number of inputs
Connection
Nominal input
values
Voltage
Current
Sensor supply (ripple included)
Input limit values At state1
Voltage
Current
At state 0
Voltage
Current
Input impedance at state 1
Configurable
State 0 to 1
response time
State 1 to 0
EC 1131-2 conformity
Proximity sensor compatibility 2/3-wire
Isolation resistance
Type of input
Consumption
Dissipated power
Isolation
Between channels and ground
Between channels and internal logic
References:
pages 2/13 and 2/14
Connections :
V
mA
V
mA
V
mA
K
ms
ms
W
V rms
V rms
c 24 (positive
c 24 (negative
c 24 (positive logic)
logic)
logic )
9
6
7
1930 (possible up to 34 V, limited to 1 hour per 24 hours)
u 11
y8
u 11
> 2.5
>6
> 2.5
<5
> Ual - 5
<5
< 1,5
<2
< 1.5
2.4
4
3,4
0.17.5
0.17.5
Yes, type 1
Yes, type 2
Yes, type 1
Yes
> 10 at c 500 V
Resistive
Current sink
Resistive
See page 6/4
TSX DEZ 12D2: 2,7
TSX DEZ 12D2K: 2,7
3
TSX DMZ 28DR: 4.5
TSX DEZ 32D2: 6
1500 - 50/60 Hz for 1 minute
1500 - 50/60 Hz for1 minute
TSX DMZ 28DTK/DMZ 28DT
TSX DMZ 64DTK
TSX ACZ 03 (3)
16
32
8
HE 10 connector/screw terminal
HE 10 connector
SUB- D connector
block
c 24 (positive logic)
7
3.5
8
1930 (possible up to 34 V, limited to 1 hour per 24 hours)
u 11
> 2.5
<5
<5
<5
< 1.5
< 1.4
< 1.4
3.4
6.3
2.67
0.17.5
1/1.5 (fixe)
0.17.5
0.2/0.3 (fixe)
Yes, type 1
Yes
> 10 at c 500 V
Resistive
Current sink
Resistive
See page 6/4
5
2
2.1
Connections:
pages 2/15 to 2/17
2/9
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics (continued)
Connection
Nominal input
values
a 100120
a 200240
a 100120
50 Hz
mA
11
10
11
60 Hz
mA
13
12
13
Frequency
Hz
4763
Sensor supply
85132
170264
85132
Voltage
u 74
u 120
u 74
Current
mA
u 6 (for U = 74 V)
u 6 (for U = 164 V)
u 6 (for U = 74 V)
Voltage
< 20
< 40
< 20
Current
mA
<4
<5
<4
50 Hz
ms
1118
60 Hz
ms
916
50 Hz
ms
1124
60 Hz
ms
1022
Yes, type 1
Yes, type 2
1.4
5.6
At state 0
Response time
State 0 to 1
State 1 to 0
Yes, type 2
Yes
Isolation resistance
> 10 at c 500 V
Type of input
Capacitive
Consumption
Dissipated power
Isolation
Voltage
Current
2.1
1.7
V rms
V rms
References:
pages 2/13 and 2/14
Connections :
Connections:
pages 2/15 to 2/17
2/10
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics (continued)
(1)
Type of modules
Number of outputs
Connection
Nominal output values
48
Response time
From state 1
ms
< 0.5
(2)
From state 0
ms
< 0.5
Switching frequency on inductive load
Hz
< 0.6/LI2
Built-in protection
Against overvoltages
By Zener diode
Against reverse polarity
By reverse mounted diode on power supply. Provide 1 fast-blow fuse on the + c 24 V of the
preactuator supply.
Against short-circuits and
A
By current limiter and thermal breaker
overloads
0.75 y Id y 2
Paralleling of outputs
2 outputs max.
Consumption
See page 6/4
Nominal dissipated power Via module
W
3.5
3.2
Via channel at 1
W
0.15
Isolation(test voltage)
Between output and ground V rms 1500 - 50/60 Hz for 1 minute
Between outputs and
V rms 1500 - 50/60 Hz for 1 minute
internal logic
Insulation resistance
M
> 10 at c 500 V
Type of modules
Nombre of sorties
Connection
Nominal output values
Logic
Leakage current at state 0
mA
Residual voltage
Minimum load impedance
Response time
From state 1
(2)
From state 0
Switching frequency on inductive load
Built-in protection
Against overvoltages
Against reverse polarity
Against short-circuits and
overloads
Paralleling of outputs
Consumption
Nominal dissipated power Via module
Via channel at 1
Isolation(test voltage)
Between output and ground
Between outputs and
internal logic
Insulation resistance
References:
pages 2/13 and 2/14
Connections :
V
A
W
V
A
ms
ms
Hz
W
W
V rms
V rms
M
2
2.1
c 24
2
0.5
0.1
15
10
1.2 max.
1930 (possible up to 34 V, limited at 1 hour per 24 hours)
2.5
0.625
0.25
Positive, current emis
< 0.5
< 0.5 ( < 2 for accidental
< 0.1
disconnection of the 0 V
module)
< 0.8 (for I = 2 A)
< 0.3 (for I = 500 mA)
< 1.5
12
48
220
<1
< 0.5
< 0.25
<1
< 0.5
< 0.25
< 0.5/LI2
< 0.6/LI.
< 0.5/LI
By Zener diode
By reverse mounted diode on power supply. Provide 1 fast-blow fuse on the + c 24 V of the
preactuator supply.
By current limiter and
By current limiter and thermal By current limiter and
elecctronic breaker
breaker
elecctronic breaker
2.6 y Id y 5
0.75 y Id y 2
0.125 y Id y 0.185
2 outputs max.
3 outputs max.
See page 6/4
3.8
3
3.5
1.15 (U = 24 V)
0.15
< 0.7 (U = 24 V)
1500 - 50/60 Hz for 1 minute
1500 - 50/60 Hz for 1 minute
> 10 at c 500 V
(1) Characteristics at 60 C for 60 % I/O loading or at 30 C for 100 % I/O loading.
(2) All outputs have fast demagnetisation circuits for electro-magnets. Discharge time of
electro-magnets < L/R.
Connections:
pages 2/15 to 2/17
2/11
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics (continued)
TSX DSZ
08R5
8
Number of outputs
a
c
V
V
Type of contact
Response time
Built-in
protection
32
19264
1034
Voltage
Power
V
VA
24
50 (8)
48
50 (10)
110 (7)
110
110 (10)
220 (7)
220
220 (10)
24
50 (6)
48
100 (5)
110120 200240
200 (4)
200 (6)
Inductive AC - 14 Voltage
and AC - 15
Power
V
VA
24
24 (7)
48
10 (15)
24 (13)
110
10 (16)
50 (12)
110 (3)
220
10 (16)
50 (14)
110 (10),
220 (2)
24
24 (2)
48
50 (2)
110120 200240
10 (9)
10 (11)
50 (3)
50 (5)
Resistive DC-12
Voltage
Power
V
W
24
24 (1 x 106 cycles of operations)
40 (0.3 x 106 cycles of operations)
24
12 (0.5 x 106 cycles of operations)
24 (0.3 x 106 cycles of operations)
48 (0.15 x 106 cycles of operations)
Inductive DC - 13 Voltage
(L/R = 60 ms)
Power
V
W
24
10 (2 x 106 cycles of operations)
24 (1 x 106 cycles of operations)
24
6 (0.12 x 106 cycles of operations)
12 (0.06 x 106 cycles of operations)
24 (0.03 x 106 cycles of operations)
Activation
ms
< 10
Desactivation
ms
< 10
Resistive AC-12
2.1
d.c. load
NO
Thermal current
a.c. load
None, obligatory mounting of a fast blow fuse per channels or groups of channels
None, obligatory parallel mounting of a RC circuit or an MOV (ZNO) peak limiter appropriate to
the voltage
None, obligatory mounting of a flywheel diode on the terminals of each preactuator
See page 6/4
TSX DSZ
08R5
1.5
Isolation (test
voltage)
V rms
V rms
M
References:
pages 2/13 and 2/14
Connections :
Connections:
pages 2/15 to 2/17
2/12
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
References
Discrete input modules
Nature of current
Input voltage
24 V (positive
logic
IEC type 2)
Modularity
(no.of
channels)
12
Format
Connection
Reference
Weight
kg
Half
0.160
32
Standard
Via HE 10 type
TSX DEZ 12D2K
connector
(1)
Via screw terminal TSX DEZ 32D2
block (supplied)
0.290
24 V ((positive 12
logic IEC type 1
or (negative
logic)
Half
0.230
100120 V
IEC type 2
Half
0.230
200240 V
IEC type 1
Half
0.230
Format
Connection
Reference
Half
Via HE 10 type
connector (1)
2.1
c
solid state protected
Weight
kg
0.180
0.240
32
Standard
0.420
24 V/2 A
protected
Half
0.310
c 24 V
or
a 24240 V
Half
0.260
32
Standard
0.580
28
TSX DMZ 16DTK
Number, type
of inputs
8, c 24 V
(positive logic
IEC type 1)
Connection
16, c 24 V
(positive logic
IEC type 1)
Via HE 10 type
connector (1)
Characteristics:
pages 2/9 to 2/12
Via HE 10 type
TSX DMZ 16 DTK
connector (1) and
enclosed terminal
block
TSX DMZ 28DTK
Weight
kg
0.160
0.330
0.465
12, relay
Standard
50 VA
not protected
0.500
16
12, relay
Standard
a 100120 V 50 VA
IEC type 2
not protected
0.500
32, c 24 V
(positive logic
IEC type 1)
Via HE 10 type
connector (1)
0.410
16, c 24 V
(positive logic
IEC type 1 or
negative logic
64
Reference
Connections:
pages 2/15 to 2/17
2/13
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References (continued)
References
(continued)
Constitution Section
Use
20-wire
1 HE 10 type
0.324 mm2
preformed
connector,
cable
moulded
(500 mA max.) 1 end free with
wires identified
Length
Reference
3m
Weight
kg
0.405
5m
0.720
10 m
1.210
1m
0.090
2m
0.170
3m
0.250
0.5 m
0.085
1m
0.150
2m
0.280
3m
0.410
5m
0.670
10 m
1.230
2.1
2 HE 10 type
0.08 mm2
connectors for
Telefast 2
system
Connecting
2 HE 10 type
cables
connectors,
(500 mA max.) moulded, for
Telefast 2,
Tego Dial et
Tego Power
systems
0.324 mm2
2 01
2 01
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Telefast 2
16-channel simulator
sub-base for discrete
inputs/outputs
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
Use
Reference
ABE 7TES160
Has 2 HE 10 type connectors
which enable it to be inserted
between the PLC I/O module
and the ABE 7H/P/R/S Telefast 2
I/O sub-base.
Used for display, forcing,
inhibition or continuity of discrete
I/O
Weight
kg
0.350
Replacement parts
ABE 7TES160
Description
Use
Characteristics:
pages 2/9 to 2/12
Connections:
pages 2/15 to 2/17
Reference
TSX BLZ H01
Weight
kg
0.055
0.115
2/14
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connections
Connections
TSX DEZ 12D2K
Positive logic
Positive logic
Inputs
Inputs
Sensors
0
1
5
6
8
9
10
11
12
9
10
13
13
13
(1)
14
24 V
14
(1)
14
15
15
15
16
17
18
19
20
11
12
11
12
10
11
10
11
11
2.1
10
10
5
6
7
7
4
6
4
5
3
3
Inputs
Sensors
Sensors
1
Negative logic
24 V
(1)
24 V
Sensors
Outputs
1
0
1
2
3
2
3
4
5
4
5
6
7
6
7
8
9
8
9
10
11
10
11
12
13
12
13
14
15
14
16
15
Preactuators
0
1
3
21
1
2
22
23
3
24
25
4
5
26
27
6
7
8
28
29
9
30
10
11
31
12
32
33
13
34
35
FU1
14
15
4
6
7
7
8
10
11
11
13
14
+ 24 V
14
FU2 (2)
+ 24 V
0
1
16
FU1
18
(3)
FU2
17
19
20
27
29
6
8
13
33
12
6
7
15
35
26
27
9
10
28
29
11
12
30
31
13
14
34
24
25
32
14
22
23
30
31
21
28
11
20
26
10
18
19
1
24
25
16
23
15
17
22
14
15
(3)
21
12
13
13
15
15
11
12
13
14
10
11
12
12
8
9
10
10
6
7
8
9
4
5
2
3
Outputs
1
5
5
+
0
0
2
FU1 (2)
20
Preactuators
18
19
Outputs
1
17
FU3
(3)
32
33
15
34
35
Characteristics:
pages 2/9 to 2/12
References:
pages 2/13 and 2/14
2/15
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connections (continued)
Inputs
Sensors
6
7
2
3
4
5
2
2
Outputs
1
Preactuators
0
Preactuators
1
2
3
Outputs
9
10
10
10
11
2.1
11
12
12
11
24 V
13
12
(2)
13
(1)
14
14
13
14
15
15
24 V
(2)
15
16
17
18
19
20
Sensors
0
1
Sensors
Inputs
Inputs
Sensors
Inputs
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
11
11
10
14
14
16
(1)
(1)
B
0
(3)
20
20
21
21
2
18
24 V
19
19
0
15
17
18
24 V
14
16
15
17
(1)
13
14
15
15
15
12
13
13
14
11
12
11
12
13
10
11
10
12
13
10
10
12
24 V
8
9
6
7
6
7
3
4
2
4
2
2
22
22
23
3
2
23
4
(3)
24
5
4
25
6
7
6
10
28
11
12
24 V
24 V
14
15
17
16
Preactuators
Outputs
19
29
28
32
10
31
9
34
Outputs
(3)
32
33
11
34
35
Outputs
19240 V
24 V
Preactuators
20
Preactuators
Characteristics:
pages 2/9 to 2/12
35
18
30
30
33
(2)
(2)
(3)
31
11
13
27
29
10
11
26
5
27
10
26
24
25
References:
pages 2/13 and 2/14
2/16
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connections (continued)
Connections (continued)
TSX DSZ 04T22
Preactuators
Outputs
Preactuators
(2)
Outputs
(2)
(2)
Sensors
10
10
5
11
Inputs
8
9
4
4
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Outputs
11
Preactuators
2
2.1
12
12
(1)
4
5
24 V
3
3
Inputs
Sensors
13
(2)
13
(3)
14
14
7
15
15
24 V
(4)
19240 V
24 V
24 V
Sensors
Inputs
0
1
2
A1/A0
Inputs
Sensors
1
10
11
11
12
13
13
14
15
15
16
17
18
19
20
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
10
11
12
12
13
14
14
15
16
17
(3)
110 V
18
(3)
19
(2)
20
24 V
21
1
2
22
B1/B0
23
3
(2)
24
26
28
30
32
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
25
4
5
27
29
(2)
8
31
9
10
(2)
N of channels
A1
A0
16
0
17
1
18
2
19
3
20
4
21
5
22
6
23
7
24
8
25
9
26
10
27
11
28
12
29
13
30
14
31
15
33
11
34
35
Outputs
19240 V
24 V
Preactuators
24 V
(5)
Outputs
N of channels
B1
B0
16
0
17
1
18
2
19
3
20
4
21
5
22
6
23
7
24
8
25
9
26
10
27
11
28
12
29
13
30
14
31
15
white
brown
green
yellow
grey
pink
blue
red
black
purple
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
grey/pink
red/blue
white/green
brown/green
white/yellow
yellow/brown
white/grey
grey/brown
white/pink
pink/brown
Preactuators
Characteristics:
pages 2/9 to 2/12
References:
pages 2/13 and 2/14
2/17
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Safety
Production workshops and technical building installations are subject to increasing requirements in terms of machine
safety
2
2.1
A good machine is a safe machine, combining:
b Safety of personnel (machine is not dangerous).
b Availability of the production tool (machine operational at any time).
b Safety is achieved by:
v simultaneously optimising safety and availability,
v using basic principles: redundancy, self-monitoring, etc,
v considering reliability (failure determining the behavior of the machine in a specified position, positive safety
features),
v ease of maintenance.
Mushroom head
emergency stop
button
Two-handel control
Safety module integrated in PLC
For further details on components for safety applications, please consult our specialist catalogue.
2/18
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation (continued)
In the case of failure, the safety function (1) is compromised. Therefore, a reliable
intermediate relay system must be used.
(1) A safety function is a function whose non-execution or untimely execution results in the
immediate placement of the equipment into a non-hazardous position.
KM1
2
2.1
Feedback loop
KM6
KM5
Emergency stop
KM5
KM5
KM6
KM6
Run
Redundancy
KM6
KM5
KM5 and KM6 contactors with mechnically linked contacts
2/19
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description
Presentation
The TSX DPZ 10D2A Emergency stop monitoring module integrated into the
TSX Micro PLC combines:
b The ease of use of Preventa safety modules.
b PLC diagnostics performance.
It also maintains all the advantages of a standard PLC (extended choice of I/O, ease
of installation, flexibility of hardware and software developments, etc).
TSX Micro
The TSX DPZ 10D2A Emergency stop monitoring module combines a Preventa
(XPS) hard-wired safety relay and a discrete acquisition function in a half-slot, for full
diagnostics of input contacts and the state of safety circuit outputs.
Safety
relay
2.1
K4
The TSX DPZ 10D2A safety module is used to interrupt one or more Emergency or
safety stop control circuits in complete safety, in accordance with EN 60204-1.
The proven safety of hard-wired technology and the capacity of the TSX Micro PLC
make module TSX DPZ 10D2A the optimum solution for making machines more
reliable, safer, more compact and more cost-effective.
K3
K4
K3
Description
Emergency stop monitoring module TSX DPZ 10D2A comprises:
1
1 A metal casing with a locking system for fixing the module in its slot. This system
is only accessible when the screw terminal block is removed.
Characteristics:
page 2/22
3 A cover giving access to the screw terminal block, which also holds the marker
legend.
References:
page 2/22
Connections:
page 2/23
2/20
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions
2
2.1
Schematic diagram
To ensure correct operation of the safety function whatever the first failure, the following must be used :
b At the inputs: Emergency stop pushbuttons or safety limit switches with dual contacts.
b At the outputs: if relaying is required, use relays with guided contacts.
b Module power supply: use an F1 protection fuse (see characteristics on page 2/22).
F1
14
S4
12
S5
10
S6
8
S7
Ix,4
Ix,5
Ix,6
Ix,7
Ix,9
K1
ESC
5
K2 K1
4
7
S3
K2
Ix,8
Ix,3
9
S2
Bus interface
K3 K4
Isolation
S8
Ix,2
Bus
11
S1
Ix,1
13
Ix,0
S0
15
0V
3
K3
K4
N(-)
6-7
1-2 et 1-3
4-5
14-15
14-12, 12-10, 10-8, 8-6,
7-9, 9-11, 11-13, 13-15
L1(+)
F2
K2
K1
2
1
Functional diagram
2
1
Characteristics:
page 2/22
References:
page 2/22
Connections:
page 2/23
2/21
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics,
references
Whole machine
Product
PLC
Certifications
2
2.1
General characteristics
Power supply
Nominal voltage
Limit operating voltage
Error signalling
Maximum consumption
Conforming IEC 947-5-1
V
V
V
mA
A
mA
kV
c 24
c 21.630
c < 16
< 200
1 (gl)
< 20
4 (overvoltage category III, degree of pollution 2)
A
V rms
W
c 24
8
1
Positive
10/100 s
1500 - 50/60 Hz for 1 minute
< 4.5
V
V
A
mA
V
VA
V
VA
2 volt-free outputs
a 19264
c 17250
1.25
10
a 24
a 48
30
60
c 24
30
Logic
Inrush current
Isolation between input and earth
Power
Dissipated in the module
a.c.
d.c.
Inductive
AC-15 duty
Inductive
DC-13 duty
(L/R = 100 ms)
Voltage
Power
Voltage
Power
Response time
Type of contacts
External output protection via
Conforming IEC 947-5-1
F2 fuse
Isolation between input and earth Insulation voltage conforming DIN VDE 0110 part 2
Test voltage
ms
A
< 100
AgNi gold flashed
4 (gl)
V
V rms
300
2000-50/60 Hz for 1 minute
Operation
Stockage
C
C
mm2
mm2
- 10 C+ 60 C
- 25 C+ 60 C
IP 20 conforming IEC 529
1 x 0.8 minimum
2 x 1 maximum
a 110
140
a 220
165
Environment
Temperatures
Degree of protection
Connecting cable c.s.a.
Reference
Inputs number
Voltage
Safety outputs
2 N/O (volt-free)
1.25 A (l the)
Connection
Format
Via screw terminal
block (suplied)
Half-format
Reference
TSX DPZ 10D2A
Weight
kg
0.280
Connections:
page 2/23
2/22
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connections
F1
24V
24V
14
14
S4
S4
12
12
S5
S5
10
10
S6
S6
S7
S7
ESC
5
K3 K4
S8
K3 K4
S8
7
S3
S2
S3
K3
11
K4
S1
6
ESC
13
S2
2.1
K3
11
K4
S1
13
S0
S0
0V
15
0V
15
3
3
2
K3
K4
L1(+)
F2
K3
K4
L1(+)
F2
N(-)
N(-)
The states of all the contacts in the input circuit are read by the PLC. The
consistency test carried out by the PLC program on the input contacts enables
it to signal and locate precisely the faulty contact(s).
When using less than 4 dual contacts, the input terminals not in use must be
linked. For example, if contacts S0 and S4 are not in use, a bridge is required
between terminals 14 and 12 and terminals 13 and 15.
F1
24V
Suitable for use with existing wiring; with one contact on the safety module and
one contact for diagnostics, this wiring enables global reading of the state of
contacts S4 to S7 and individual reading of contacts S0 to S3.
The consistency test carried out by the PLC program on the inputs enables it to
signal any inconsistency with partial location of the fault.
24V
14
F1
S4
15
12
14
S5
10
S6
S7
ESC
S8
ESC
K3
S8
K3
K4
4
7
L1(+)
9
11
13
K4
24V
3
2
1
F1
K3
0V
15
14
K4
K3
L1(+)
F2
7
6
K3
N(-)
Not all faults are detected. A short-circuit on a pushbutton or limit switch is not
detected.
When using less than 4 single contacts, the input terminals not in use must be
linked.
For example, if contact S5 is not in use, a bridge is required between terminals
10 and 12.
K4
N(-)
Characteristics:
page 2/22
F2
15
0V
K3
6
5
K4
K4
3
2
1
References:
pages 2/22
2/23
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Presentation
The TSX STZ 10 I/O extension module is used to connect up to 4 Nano devices,
which may be PLC bases, analogue I/O extensions or a discrete I/O extension.
These remotely installed Nano bases or extensions (200 metres maximum from the
TSX Micro PLC) can be used as :
b I/O of the Micro PLC. In this case the number of I/O managed by the TSX Micro PLC
can be increased by 96 discrete I/O or 12 analogue I/O.
b Local slave PLCs (1) with data exchanges from application to application
between Micro and each Nano base (the maximum number of Nano bases is limited
to 3). In this application, an FTX 117 terminal or PL7 07 software is required for
software installation on Nano slave PLCs.
2.1
TSX
Micro
Analogue Nano
extension (3 inputs/
1 output)
Length 200 m
Configuration:
One to four Nano PLC bases with 10, 16 or 24 I/O, i.e. a maximum of 96 discrete I/O.
Analogue Nano
extension (3 inputs/
1 output)
Length 200 m
Nano base
slave
Nano base
slave
Nano base
slave
Mixed configuration
Analogue Nano extension
(3 inputs/1 output)
TSX
Micro
master
It is possible to combine both types of configuration on one link, in which case the
maximum number of Nano PLCs is limited to 4.
Length 200 m
Nano base
slave
Nano
base
24 I/O
Nano base
slave
References :
page 2/25
2/24
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Description,
selection,
reference
Description
The front panel of the TSX STZ 10 I/O extension module for Nano PLCs comprises :
2
1
Extensions 9
inputs/7 outputs (2)
Extensions 14
inputs/10 outputs (2)
Analogue extensions
(3 inputs, 1 output) (3)
Power supply
a
c
100/240 V 24 V
2.1
Reference
I/O extension module for Nano PLCs
The TSX STZ 10 half-format module can be inserted in position 4 which means that
its use excludes integration of the TSX SAZ 10 AS-Interface bus module.
Description
Remote discrete
I/O extension
module
Use
Format
TSX 37 10
Half
TSX 37 21/22
PLCs
Connections
Reference
Via terminal
TSX STZ 10
block integrated
in module
Weight
kg
0.180
TSX STZ 10
Presentation :
page 2/24
2/25
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection guide
Telefast
2 pre-wired system
817437
817438
Applications
2.2
Relay amplification
Control voltage
c 24 V
Output voltage
c 24 V
0.5 A
Modularity
16
1 to 3
Signal
Signal, common
(configurable
c 24 V or 0 V)
Signal
Signal, Common
(configurable c 24 V or 0 V)
Connectors
Terminal block
removable
No
No
Screw
Screw or spring
type of terminals
8 -12 -16
Additional or optional*
function
Miniature sub-bases
Compact size *
Type 2 input *
(1)
Isolator *
Device type
ABE7H20Eppp
7H32Eppp
ABE7H16Cpp
ABE7HppR1p
7HppR50
ABE7HppR2p
ABE7HppS21
Pages
2/34
2/35
2/26
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
521500
817432
No
Yes
2.2
c 24 V
c 24 V
0.5 A
c 24 V (solid state)
c 5... 24 V, a 230 V (electromechanical)
0.5 A
16
5 A (th)
16
8 passive inputs
8 relay outputs
Signal,
2 common connections between
the inputs and the outputs.
Signal, common,
2 common connections between
the inputs and the outputs.
No
Screw
Miniature sub-base
Synergy with Tego Power and API Micro PLC
ABE-7H16CM11
ABE-7P16M111
ABE-7R16M111
2/38
2/37
2/34
ABE-7H16CM21
2/27
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection guide
Telefast
2 pre-wired system
Discrete output
817440
Applications
2.2
Relay amplification
Electromechanical, fixed
Yes
Yes
Control voltage
c 24 V
Output voltage
c 5 V... 30 V
a 230 V
2 A (th)
3 A (th)
Modularity
8 - 16
1 N/O contact
and common
Volt-free
1 N/O contact
Connectors
20-way HE 10 connector
Terminal block
removable
Yes
type of terminals
Yes
No
No
c 5 V... 150 V
a 230 V
c 24 V (solid state)
c 5 V... 24 V, a 230 V (E.M.)
c 5 V... 150 V
a 230 V
5 A (th)
2 A (solid state),
6 A (electromechanical)
Depends on
relay mounted
0.5 to 10 A
16
8 or 16
2 to 3
1 N/O contact
and common
1 N/O contact
Signal,
Polarities
Yes
No
No
Screw
Screw or spring
Screw or spring
Additional or optional*
function
Miniature
sub-base
Bistable relay
Volt-free
or common per 8 channels
Miniature sub-bases
Common per 4 channels
Device type
ABE7R08S216p
ABE7RppS1pp
ABE7R16T111
ABE7P16T111
ABE7P16T2ppp
7P08T3ppp
Pages
2/36
2/37
2/38
ABE7RppS2pp
2/28
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
817439
Discrete input
Electromechanical, removable
Solid state,
removable
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
From c 24 V
to a 230 V
From 5 V TTL
to a 230 V
c 5 V... 150 V
a 230 V
5A (th)
2.2
c 24 V
8 A (th)
from 0.5 to 2 A
2 to 3
2 to 6
1 C/O contact or
1 N/O contact
and common
1 C/O contact or
2 C/O contacts
and common
125 mA
0.5 A
125 mA
12 mA
Signal and 0 V
Signal
c 24 V and 0 V
Signal can be
Signal
isolated, Protected
common
16
No
Yes
Screw
Screw or spring
Fault signal
3-wire proximity
sensor
ABE7SppS2Bp
ABE7H16F43
ABE7H16R3p
ABE7H16S43
ABE7S16E2pp
ABE7P16F31p
2/36
2/35
2/36
2/39
8 channels
4 channels
ABE7R16T2pp
ABE7R16T3pp
2/37
No
No
Yes
Screw
Screw or spring
Signal
and common
No
2/29
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
2 pre-wired system
Analogue sub-bases
Applications
Compatibility
TSX Micro
Premium
Standard
Type of signal
Counter inputs
and analogue I/O
Counter inputs
Axis control
Position control
Analogue inputs
Current
Voltage
Pt 100
Functions
Modularity
Control voltage
c 24 V
Output voltage
c 24 V
Output current
per channel
25 mA
Number of terminals
per channel
2 or 4
Type of connector
25-way SUB-D
Terminal block
removable
No
No
Screw
Screw
Device type
ABE-7CPA01
ABE-7CPA02
Pages
2/42
2.2
type of terminals
Analogue outputs
Current
Voltage
4 channels
2 or 4
ABE-7CPA21
2/30
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
817434
817435
817435
Premium
TSX AEY810
Premium
TSX CAYp1
TSX CTY2C
Premium
TSX AEY1614
Premium
TSX PAY2p2
Analogue inputs
Current
Voltage
Pt 100
Inputs
Counter
I/O
Distribution of sensor
power supplies per limiter
(25 mA)
Connection of
16 thermocouples with
cold junction compensation
Safety module
(BG)
8 channels
8 channels
1 channel
16 channels
12 Emergency stops
2.2
2 or 4
25-way SUB-D
25-way SUB-D
15-way SUB-D
25-way SUB-D
50-way SUB-D
No
No
No
No
No
Screw
Screw or spring
Screw
Screw
Screw
ABE-7CPA03
ABE-7CPA31p
ABE-7CPA11
ABE-7CPA12
ABE-7CPA13
2/31
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Telefast
2 pre-wired system
Connection cables for Micro PLCs
2
0/15
3
0/7
8/15
2
2.2
2
U1
1 I/O modules equipped with HE 10 connectors. Available in modules of 8, 12, 28 and 64 I/O.
2 A single type of cable equipped with 20-way HE 10 connectors irrespective of the 8, 12 or 16-channel modularity.
The HE 10 connectors may be moulded (TSX CDPppp) or self-perforating (ABF-H20Hppp).
These cables are available in 0.5, 1, 2, 3 and 5 metre lengths. They use AWG 28 (0.08 mm2) for connection of inputs
and relay sub-bases, and AWG 22 (0.324 mm2) for direct connection of the 8 and 28 I/O module 0.5 A outputs.
3
Schneider Electric
2/32
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Compatibility
Telefast
2 pre-wired system
Micro PLC I/O modules and interface sub-bases
TSX
8I+8Q
1 x 16 I
1 x 12 Q
37 10 128DTK1
With modules
TSX
TSX
TSX
Counter
Auxiliary
inputs
Inputs
Outputs
2 x 16 I
2 x 16 Q
37 10 164DTK1
1 x 12 I
1x8Q
DMZ 64DTK
CTZ 2A
Analogue
and
counter
37 22 001
CTZ 1A
CTZ 2A
37 22 101
Counter
Connection sub-bases
8 chans.
12 chans.
ABE-7H08Rpp
(1)
(1)
(1)
ABE-7H08S21
(1)
(1)
(1)
ABE- (2)
7H08R10
ABE-7H12Rpp
2.2
ABE-7H012S21
16 chans.
ABE-7H16Rpp/H16Cpp/
H20Eppp
ABE- (3)
7H016R20
ABE-7H16S21
ABE-7H16R23
ABE-7H16F43
ABE-7H16S43
Input adaptor sub-bases
16 chans.
ABE-7S16E2pp
(5)
ABE-7P16F3pp
(5)
ABE-7H16CMp1
ABE-7p16M111
16 chans.
ABE-7S08S2pp
(1)
ABE-7R08Sppp
(1)
ABE-7P08T330
(1)
ABE-7S16Sppp
ABE-7R16Sppp
(4)
ABE-7R16Tppp
(4)
ABE-7P16Tppp
(4)
Schneider Electric
2/33
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Telefast
2 pre-wired system
Connection sub-bases for analogue and counter channels
Functions
Counting and
analogue
For
PLCs
Modicon
TSX Micro
Type of Reference
connection
Weight
kg
ABE-7CPA01
0.300
Counting
Modicon
Axis control
Premium
Position control
TSX CTYpA
TSX CAYp1
ABE-7CPA01
0.300
Parallel output
absolute
encoder
connection
TSX CTYpA
TSX CAYp1
ABE-7CPA11
0.330
Distribution
Modicon
of 16
Premium
thermocouples
ABE-7CPA12
0.300
Passive
distribution
of 8 channels
on screw
terminal block
with shielding
continuity
TSX 47/107
Modicon
Premium
ABE-7CPA02
0.290
Distribution
of 4 analogue
output
channels
Modicon
Premium
TSX ASY410
TSX AEY420
ABE-7CPA21
0.210
Distribution
and supply
of 8 analogue
channels
with limitation
of each
current loop
TSX 47/107
Modicon
Premium
ABE-7CPA03
0.330
TSX AEY810
ABE-7CPA31
0.410
ABE-7CPA31E
0.410
Safety
TSX PAY2p2
ABE-7CPA13
0.290
2/40
Type of
connection
Telefast 2 side
Integrated
analogue
and counter
TSX 37.22
TSX CTZpA
ABE-7CPA02
2.2
Compatible
modules
Modicon
Premium
Modicon
Premium
Spring
Schneider Electric
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Telefast
2 pre-wired system
Accessories for connection sub-bases
816483
Software
Description
Operating system
Reference
Software for
client label marking
Under Windows
version 3.1 or 95
ABE-7LOGV10
0.350
ABE-7LOGF25
0.200
Accessories
ABE-7ACC02
Description
No. of
Characteristics
channels
Order in
Unit
multiples of reference
10
ABE-7ACC01
0.008
16 as 2 x 8 channels
ABE-7ACC02
0.075
16 as 2 x 16 channels 1
ABE-7ACC10
0.075
16 as 2 x 16 channels 1
ABE-7ACC11
0.075
10 mm wide
ABE-7ACC20
0.007
12 mm wide
ABE-7ACC21
0.010
100
ABE-7ACC30
0.100
Enclosure feedthrough
with industrial connector
32
40-way
ABE-7ACC80
0.300
Plug-in 40-way
male connector
32
For mounting on
ABE-7ACC80
ABE-7ACC81
0.370
Enclosure feedthrough
16
19-way
with CNOMO M23 connector
(1 x 20-way HE 10
8 and 12 19-way
connector, PLC end)
ABE-7ACC82
0.150
ABE-7ACC83
0.150
Impedance adaptor
for Type 2 compatibility
ABE-7ACC85
0.012
IP 65 cable gland
For 3 cables
ABE-7ACC84
0.300
Additional snap-on
terminal blocks
(shunted terminals)
10 screw terminals
ABE-7BV10
0.030
10 spring terminals
ABE-7BV10E
0.030
20 screw terminals
ABE-7BV20
0.060
20 spring terminals
ABE-7BV20E
0.060
816480
816481
ABE-7ACC80 + ABE-7ACC81
816482
ABE-7BV20
2 01
2 01
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
816479
ABE-7TES160
816484
Weight
kg
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Weight
kg
I/O simulator
sub-base
16
Display, forcing
inhibition, continuity
ABE-7TES160
0.350
For 6 characters
50
AR1-SB3
0.001
0.125 A
0.5 A
1A
2A
4A
6.3 A
10
10
10
10
10
10
ABE-7FU012
ABE-7FU050
ABE-7FU100
ABE-7FU200
ABE-7FU400
ABE-7FU630
0.010
0.010
0.010
0.010
0.010
0.010
AR1-SB3
2.2
ABF-C08Rppp
Schneider Electric
For
common
Flexible
Coil
commoning
links
a
Modularity
8 x 1 mm2
c
Colour
White
Red
Blue
Distance between
cable ends
cm
12
2
12
2
12
2
Reference
ABF-C08R12W
ABF-C08R02W
ABF-C08R12R
ABF-C08R02R
ABF-C08R12B
ABF-C08R02B
Weight
kg
0.020
0.010
0.020
0.010
0.020
0.010
2/41
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
816461
816460
Input
or
Output
16
Length
Type
Reference
of PLC
of
connection connection
cable
m
Modicon TSX
Micro/Premium
Weight
kg
Screw
ABE-7H20E100
0.330
Screw
ABE-7H20E200
0.410
Screw
ABE-7H20E300
0.480
1.5
Screw
ABE-7H32E150
0.360
Screw
ABE-7H32E300
0.460
ABE-7H20Eppp
2.2
Siemens S7
"Miniature" sub-bases
Function No. No. of terminals
of
per on
chan- chan- row
nels nel number
16
816462
Input
or
Output
816463
ABE-7H16C21
Input
16
and
Output (1)
LED
per
channel
Polarity
distribution
Type
Reference
of
connection
No
No
Screw
ABE-7H16C10
0.160
Yes
No
Screw
ABE-7H16C11
0.160
Weight
kg
Yes
0 or 24 V
Screw
ABE-7H16C21
0.205
Yes
0 and 24 V
Screw
ABE-7H16C31
0.260
Yes
No
Screw
ABE-7H16CM11
0.160
Yes
0 or 24 V
Screw
ABE-7H16CM21
0.200
ABE-7H16CM21
(1) 8 I + 8 Q : these products have 2 commons connections which enable inputs and outputs to be connected to the same
sub-base at the same time.
Schneider Electric
2/34
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Function
ABE-7H16R50
Input
or
Output
No.
of
channels
12
816465
16
Weight
kg
No
No
Screw
ABE-7H08R10
0.187
Yes
No
Screw
ABE-7H08R11
0.187
Yes
0 or 24 V
Screw
ABE-7H08R21
0.218
Screw
ABE-7H08S21
0.245
No
No
Screw
ABE-7H12R10
0.274
Yes
No
Screw
ABE-7H12R11
0.274
No
No
Screw
ABE-7H12R50
0.196
No
0 or 24 V
Screw
ABE-7H12R20
0.300
Yes
0 or 24 V
Screw
ABE-7H12R21
0.300
Screw
ABE-7H12S21
0.375
No
No
Screw
ABE-7H16R10
0.274
Yes
No
Screw
ABE-7H16R11
0.274
Spring
ABE-7H16R11E
0.274
Screw
ABE-7H16R50
0.196
Spring
ABE-7H16R50E
0.196
2.2
ABE-7H16R31
2
No
No
No
0 or 24 V
Screw
ABE-7H16R20
0.300
Yes
0 or 24 V
Screw
ABE-7H16R21
0.300
Spring
ABE-7H16R21E
0.300
Screw
ABE-7H16S21
0.375
Spring
ABE-7H16S21E
0.375
816466
No
0 and 24 V
Screw
ABE-7H16R30
0.346
Yes
0 and 24 V
Screw
ABE-7H16R31
0.346
Type 2
16
input (1)
Yes
0 and 24 V
Screw
ABE-7H16R23
0.320
Input
16
Yes
24 V
I, F (2)
Screw
ABE-7H16S43
0.640
Output
16
Yes
0V
I, F (2)
Screw
ABE-7H16F43
0.640
ABE-7H16p43
(1) For Modicon TSX Micro, Premium and Numerical Controller NUM 1020/1060.
(2) With LED to indicate blown fuse.
Schneider Electric
2/35
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
816467
Number No. of
Isolation
of
terminals
PLC/application
channels per channel
16
Yes
ABE-7S16E2pp
Voltage
Reference
Type
of
connection
c 24
Screw
ABE-7S16E2B1
0.370
Spring
ABE-7S16E2B1E
0.370
Screw
ABE-7S16E2E1
0.370
Spring
ABE-7S16E2E1E
0.370
Screw
ABE-7S16E2E0
0.386
Spring
ABE-7S16E2E0E
0.386
Screw
ABE-7S16E2F0
0.397
Spring
ABE-7S16E2F0E
0.397
Screw
ABE-7S16E2M0
0.407
Spring
ABE-7S16E2M0E
0.407
c 48
a 48
a 110
2.2
a 230
Weight
kg
No
c 24
Output
current
A
Fault
detection
signal (1)
Type
of
connection
Reference
0.5
Yes (2)
Screw
ABE-7S08S2B0
0.252
Spring
ABE-7S08S2B0E
0.252
Screw
ABE-7S08S2B1
0.448
Spring
ABE-7S08S2B1E
0.448
Screw
ABE-7S16S2B0
0.405
Spring
ABE-7S16S2B0E
0.405
Screw
ABE-7S16S1B2
0.400
Spring
ABE-7S16S1B2E
0.400
16
No
c 24
0.5
Yes (2)
Yes (2)
No
Weight
kg
No. of
contacts
1 N/O
Polarity
distribution/
application
ABE-7R08S111
0.244
ABE-7R08S111E
0.244
Volt-free
Screw
ABE-7R08S216
0.250
Spring
ABE-7R08S216E
0.250
Screw
ABE-7R08S210
0.352
Spring
ABE-7R08S210E
0.352
ABE-7R16S11
0.352
ABE-7R16S111E
0.352
Volt-free
ABE-7R16S210
ABE-7R16S210E
0.547
0.547
816468
Output
current
A
Bistable
10
ABE-7R08S216
16
10
1 N/O
1 N/O
1 N/O
Volt-free
Type
of
connection
Screw
Spring
Reference
Weight
kg
Common per
Screw
ABE-7R16S212
group of 8 chan. Spring
ABE-7R16S212E
on both poles
(1) A fault on a sub-base output Qn will set PLC output Qn to safety mode which will be detected by the PLC.
(2) Can only be used with modules with protected outputs.
0.547
0.547
Schneider Electric
2/36
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
816469
ABE-7R16T210
Isolation Input
PLC/
connection
application
ABS-7E
Yes
ABR-7
ABS-7S33E
Volt-free
Polarity distribution
Type
of
connection
Reference
Weight
Screw
ABE-7P16F310
0.850
Spring
ABE-7P16F310E
0.850
Screw
ABE-7P16F312
0.850
kg
2.2
816471
No. and
type of
contacts
ABR-7S11 1 N/O
ABE-7R16M111
10
ABR-7S21 1 N/O
ABR-7S23 1 C/O
12
ABR-7S33 1 C/O
ABR-7S37 2 C/O
Polarity
distribution/
application
Reference
Weight
Contact common
per group of 4 channels
ABE-7R16T111
0.600
Contact common
per group of 4 output channels
+ 2 input common terminals
ABE-7R16M111 (3)
0.600
Volt-free
ABE-7R16T210
0.735
Common
on both poles (4)
ABE-7R16T212
0.730
ABE-7R16T231
0.730
Volt-free
ABE-7R16T230
0.775
Volt-free
ABE-7R16T330
1.300
Common
on both poles (5)
ABE-7R16T332
1.200
Volt-free
ABE-7R16T370
1.300
kg
Schneider Electric
2/37
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Sub-bases for solid state and/or electromechanical output relays, plug-in (1)
No. of Relay For
chan- width relay
nels
type
mm
16
Isolator
per
channel
ABR-7S11
No
ABS-7SC1B
Fuse
per
channel
816473
2.2
ABR-7S2p No
ABS-7SA2p
ABS-7SC2p
ABE-7ACC20
No
No
16
12
12
ABR-7S33
No
ABS-7SA3p
ABS-7SC3pp
ABE-7ACC21
ABR-7S33
No
ABS-7SA3p
ABS-7SC3pp
ABE-7ACC21
ABR-7S33
No
ABS-7SA3M
ABS-7SC3E
ABE-7ACC21
Yes
Weight
Contact common
per group of 4 channels
ABE-7P16T111
0.550
Contact common
per group of 4 output
channels and 2 common
input terminals
ABE-7P16M111 (2)
0.550
Volt-free
ABE-7P16T210 (3)
0.615
ABE-7P16T230 (3)
0.655
Spring
ABE-7P16T230E (3)
0.655
Screw
Yes
Volt-free
Screw
ABE-7P16T214
0.675
No
Common
on both
poles (4)
Screw
ABE-7P16T212
0.615
Yes
Common
on both
poles (4)
Screw
ABE-7P16T215
0.670
No
Volt-free
Screw
ABE-7P08T330
0.450
Spring
ABE-7P08T330E
0.450
Screw
ABE-7P16T330
0.900
Spring
ABE-7P16T330E
0.900
Common
on both
poles (5)
Screw
ABE-7P16T332
0.900
Yes
Volt-free
Screw
ABE-7P16T334
0.900
Yes
Common
on both
poles (5)
Screw
ABE-7P16T318
1.000
Spring
ABE-7P16T318E
1.000
ABE-7P16T2pp
8
Reference
kg
10
Polarity
Type
distribution/ of
application connection
No
Volt-free
Schneider Electric
2/38
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Input circuit
Current
816475
mm
Nominal
voltage
V
Output circuit
Current (1)
Nominal
voltage
A
V
Unit
reference
Weight
kg
Output
24
c 24
ABS-7SC1B
0.010
10
Output
24
0.5
c 548
ABS-7SC2E
0.016
a 24240
ABS-7SA2M
0.016
c 24
ABS-7EC3AL
0.014
ABS-7SC1B
12
Input
Output
5 TTL
24 Type 2
c 24
ABS-7EC3B2
0.014
48 Type 2
c 24
ABS-7EC3E2
0.014
a 50 Hz
48
c 24
ABS-7EA3E5
0.014
a 60 Hz
110130
c 24
ABS-7EA3F5
0.014
a 50 Hz
230240
c 24
ABS-7EA3M5
0.014
24
2
c 24
Self-protected
ABS-7SC3BA
0.016
1.5
c 548
ABS-7SC3E
0.016
1.5
a 24240
ABS-7SA3MA
0.016
Order in
multiples of
Unit
reference
2.2
816476
ABR-7S2p
Relay
width
mm
Control
voltage
V
Output
current (1)
A (Ith)
No. of
contacts
c 24
1 N/O
ABR-7S11
0.005
10
c 24
1 N/O
ABR-7S21
0.008
1 C/O
ABR-7S23
0.008
10
1 C/O
ABR-7S33
0.017
2 C/O
ABR-7S37
0.017
1 C/O
ABR-7S33E
0.017
c 24
816474
12
c 48
ABR-7S3p
Weight
kg
Accessory
Description
Reference
ABE-7ACC12
Weight
kg
0.010
Schneider Electric
2/39
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Dimensions
Telefast
ABE-7H20Eppp
ABE-7H32Eppp
2 pre-wired system
ABE-7H16R50, ABE-7H12R50,
ABE-7H08R1p, ABE-7H08R21,
ABE-7R08S111/S111E,
ABE-7H08S21, ABE-7CPA21
ABE-7H16Cpp/ABE-7H16CMpp,
ABE-7p16M111/ABE-7p16T111
35
b1
84
a
55
15
c
c+9
7H20E/7H32Eppp
67
56
59
7Hppppp/CPA21
70
58
58
7R08S111p
77
58
58
ABEa
b
b1
c
7p16M111/T111
110
89
58
54
ABE-7H16p43
77
ABE-7R16S21p,
ABE-7S16S2B0/S2B02E,
ABE-7S16E2pp/S16E2ppE,
ABE-7S08S2B1/S08S2B1E
ABE-7CPA31
b + 12
35
b1
7H16Cpp/CMpp
106
49
41,5
60
70
2.2
ABEb
b1
c
206
15
125
c
c1
All sub-bases
b1
58
c
58
ABE-7CPA01, ABE-7CPA11/CPA12/CPA13
58
67
211
15
70
35
89
35
58
ABE7pppppp
b
70
b1
58
c
58
1 Additional shunt terminal block ABE-7BV10/7BV20
ABE-7R16T2pp, ABE-7P16T2pp
143
64
Note :
details of the front view are the same as for the ABE7CPA01.
ABE-7P08T330
73
15
89
89
35
58
272
150
74
83
Schneider Electric
2/42
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Dimensions
Telefast
ABE-7ACC02
2 pre-wired system
ABE-7ACC03
ABE-7ACC04, ABE-7ACC05
ABE-7ACC10, ABE-7ACC11
A
C
89
35
89
35
70
35
15
58
58
58
50
48
57
15
88
15
66
48
48
57
57
ABE-7ACC82, ABE-7ACC83
54
112
130
140
50
88
2.2
25
42
43
74
65
34
52
32
64,5
35
ABE-7TES160
35
89
80
103
120
58
ABE-7ACC84
15
72
43
30
54
32
170
50
59
b
G = a-12
H = b+12
ABE-7
ACC02
ACC03
ACC04
ACC05
ACC10/11
H08Rpp
H08S21
H12R50
H16R50
R08S111
CPA01
CPA02
CPA1p
CPA03
G
38
53
53
53
53
72
72
72
72
72
131
113
131
113
H
82
101
101
101
101
82
82
82
82
82
82
82
82
82
ABE-7
H12R1p
H12R2p
H16R1p
H16R2p
H16R3p
H12S21
H16S21
R08S210
R16S111
R16S21p
S08S2B0
S08S2B1
G
113
113
113
113
113
113
113
113
113
194
113
194
H
82
82
82
82
82
82
82
82
82
82
82
82
ABE-7
H16F43
H16S43
S16E2pp
S16S1B2
S16S2pp
R16T2pp
P16T2pp
R16T3pp
P08T330
P16T3pp
P16F3pp
G
194
194
194
113
194
199
199
260
150
260
260
H
82
82
82
82
82
101
101
101
101
101
101
Schneider Electric
2/43
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description
Installation system
Tego Dial for Human-Machine interfaces
Presentation
The modular Tego Dial system is used to define human-machine interfaces. It facilitates the
installation of 22, 16 and 30 mm control and signalling units, DIN format display units,
Magelis terminals and display units, XBL keypads and other products.
Tego Dial simplifies an HMI application by :
definition of the application by Tego Dial Design software,
quick assembly of dialogue and display units, through the use of modular elements,
standard connections from the dialogue units to PLCs, bus and other products,
facilitates the integration of the dialogue application into the machine, control panel, enclosure,
machine housing or intermediate suspension arm.
Description
b Tego Dial Design definition software
This software on CD-ROM facilitates graphical definition of
the dialogue application in relation to the control units, pilot
lights and display units necessary for the device.
It selects the correct Tego Dial components that are
required for the application and also features a legend
design and printing function, both for the front panel and the
connections.
2.2
3H
H = 50 mm, L = 75 mm
9H
9H
3H
4L
9H
6H
6L
4L
2L
4L
6L
4
5
b Pre-assembled kits
Dialboard and Dialpack with pre-assembled plates and
cross-pieces are available.
2/44
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Installation system
Tego Dial for Human-Machine interfaces
Standard connections
1
5
2
5
B
Other
products
D C
A
F E = 230Vac C B
Ue E D
H G
J I
points G F
L Klbase 16 I H
Dia K J
N M
230 M L
APE1B N
O
2.2
AS-i Bus
Q4
108
Q1
1
101
201
301
4
104
204
105
205
206
2/45
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Installation system
Tego Power for motor power-stater components
General presentation
Tego Power is a modular system which standardises and simplifies the
implementation of motor power-starters with its prewired control and power circuits.
Hence, installation of a motor power-starter is quick, simple, safe and flexible with no
wires needed for connection. In addition, this system enables the motor
power-starter to be customised at a later date. The system reduces maintenance
time and optimises panel space, by reducing the number of terminals, the amount of
ducting and intermediate interfaces.
Two solutions are offered :
b A solution using Quickfit technology for TeSys motor power-starter components with
spring terminals : model d contactors (9 to 32 A) and the GV2-ME motor circuit-breaker.
b A solution for TeSys motor power-starter components with screw terminals : model
d (9 to 18 A) and model k (6 to 12 A) contactors and GV2 motor circuit-breakers.
Tego Power Design definition software
This software on CD-ROM enables the motor power-starter application to be
graphically defined according to the circuit-breakers and contactors used.
It determines which Tego Power products are required for the application.
Referencing labels can also be created for the starters.
2.2
System for Quickfit technology TeSys motor power-starters with spring terminals
The motor power-starters concerned are those formed by combining :
b GV2-M circuit-breakers,
b with 9 to 32 A model d (LC1) contactors.
Consisting of simple parts, Tego Power Quickfit technology is used to create motor
starter assemblies up to 15 kW/400 V.
The main components which make up this range are :
For the power circuit
b a power kit comprising, for each starter, a plate 1 for mounting the contactor and
the circuit-breaker, and the two power connection modules 2,
b a power splitter box 5 for 2 or 4 starters,
b an upstream terminal block 6 for a power supply up to 63 A (16 mm2),
b a downstream terminal block 7 for connecting the motor power supply cables
and the earth cables (6 mm2).
For the control circuit
b a control splitter box 3 for 2 or 4 starters, with control-command data on HE 10
connector. The data on 4 to 8 starters can be fed back directly to the PLC via an 8I/8O
or 16I/8O Telefast cable or to a fieldbus module (AS-i, Fipio, CANopen, DeviceNet,
Interbus, Profibus) (see opposite page).
b a control circuit connection module 4 which plugs directly into the contactor and
the circuit-breaker on each starter. This module concentrates the motor starter
control-command data. It integrates the circuit-breaker status data in the prewiring of
the contactor control circuit.
5
4
2
2/46
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation (continued)
Installation system
Tego Power for motor power-starter components
Communication modules
General
Communication modules are used to send I/O data from a Tego Power motor powerstarter configuration to the PLC.
The communication modules is selected according to the type of connection
required :
b in parallel mode (modules, terminal blocks or HE 10),
b or in serial mode on the bus (AS-i bus, Interbus S, Fipio, Profibus DP, CANopen
or DeviceNet modules).
The communication modules are the same, whether the TeSys motor power-starter
system uses spring or screw terminals.
1
2.2
2/47
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Compatibility
Tego Dial for Human-Machine interfaces and Tego Power for motor power-starter components
Automation platform
APE 1B24M
2.2
Type
Modularity of
connection to the
PLC
Compatible I/O
modules
APE 1B24E
Tego Power
8 inputs
+ 8 outputs
16 inputs
+ 16 outputs
16 inputs
8 inputs
+ 8 outputs
16 inputs
+ 16 outputs
1 (1)
TSX DMZ
64DTK/28DTK
TSX DMZ 16DTK
1
1
Premium platform
Tego Dial
16 inputs
+ 16 outputs
16 inputs
Tego Power
16 inputs
+ 16 outputs
TSX DEY
16FK/32D2K/64D2K
TSX DSY
32T2K/64T2K
TSX DEY
16FK/32D2K/64D2K
TSX DEY
32D2K/64D2K/16FK
TSX DSY
32T2K/64T2K
1 (1)
1 (1)
Quantum platform
Tego Dial
32 inputs
+ 32 outputs
32 inputs
Tego Power
32 inputs
+ 32 outputs
1
1
16 inputs
+ 8 outputs
(1) For the connection of a second Dialbase APE 1B24M, use 2 x TSX DP pp3 connecting cables.
2/48
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connection accessories
2.2
Control splitter box Control splitter box
16 I/16 O
Splitter box
16 I + 16 O
in 2 x (8E+8S)
Splitter box
16 to 2 x 8
APP 2RH2/H4
APE 1R1628
ABE 7ACC 02
ABF M32Hpp0
1
1
1
1
1 (2)
1
3
1 (3)
2
1 (2)
1
3
1 (3)
1
1 (2)
1
1 (3)
APP 2R2E
(2 motor-starters)
APP 2R4E
1
(4 motor-starters)
(4)
(2) 8 I + 8 O remain available. To connect a second APP-1CH module or APP-2ppp 8 E + 8 S control splitter box, use a additional TSX CDP pp4 cable.
(3) 8 O remain available on ABE-7ACC02. To connect them a second AAP-2ppp 16 I/8 O control splitter box, use a additional TSX CDP pp3 cable.
(4) For 8 motor-starters, to use 2 APP 2R4E control and power splitters.
2/49
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection guide
Functions
Type of product
Single-phase, modular
switch mode power supplies
Applications
Industrial, commercial or
residential applications.
Modular format allowing
integration into panels.
Simple,
low power
equipment.
Industrial
applications,
low and medium
power.
Machine
equipment
applications.
Industrial or
commercial
applications on
sites sensitive to
mains interference.
Protection against
accidental
restarting.
Nominal power
22 W
7 W30 W
48240 W
60240 W
Input voltage
a 100240 V single-phase
a 100240 V
single-phase
c 110220 V
compatible (1)
a 100240 V
single-phase
a 100240 V
single-phase,
c 110220 V
compatible (1)
Output voltage
c 12 V
adjustable
c 24 V
adjustable
c 24 V
adjustable
c 12, 24 V or
48 V adjustable
Technology
Secondary protection
Signalling
Other characteristics
Connection by lug-
clamps possible
Mounting
Direct on 7 rail
Direct, on 7 rail
and on panel
Direct on 7 rail
cl.B
cl.A (7/15 W)
cl.B (30 W)
cl.B
EN 50081-2,
IEC 61000-6-2,
EN 60950
UL, CSA, TV
cULus, TV
EN 50081-1,
EN 50081-1,
IEC 61000-6-2, IEC 61000-6-2,
(EN 50082-2),
(EN 50082-2),
IEC 950
IEC 950, 61000-3-2
UL, CSA, TV, CTick
Device type
ABL 7RM
ABL 7CEM
ABL 7RE
Pages
2/52
2.3
Conforming to standards
Approvals
30 W
c 24 V
adjustable
Integrated, against
overloads and
short-circuits,
with manual and
automatic reset.
ABL 7RP
Schneider Electric
2/50
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Industrial applications.
Industrial applications.
In-line continuous process equipment, machine
tools, injection presses, etc.
Industrial applications.
Supply of d.c. voltage necessary for AS-i systems.
240960 W
72 W
a 2 x 380415 V 2-phase
a3x
380415 V
3-phase
a3x
400520 V
3-phase
a 100240 V single-phase
a3x
400520 V
3-phase
c 24 V
adjustable
2.3
145 W
c 30 V
2 x 72 W
c 24 V
adjustable
Direct on 7 rail
Direct on 7 rail
(except ABL-7UPS 24200 and ABL-7UPS24400)
Direct on 7 rail
cl.B
cl.B
cl.B
EN 50081-1, EN 50082-2,
EN 60950
ABL 7REQ
ABL 7UEQ
2/52
Anti-harmonic
distortion filter
ABL 7UES
EN 50081-1,
EN 50082-2,
EN 60950,
IEC 61000-3-2
cULus, c us
ABL 7UPS
ASI ABL
UL, CSA, TV
Schneider Electric
2/51
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
2.3
Phaseo power supplies are available in single-phase and 3-phase versions. They
deliver a voltage which is precise to 3%, whatever the load and whatever the type of
mains supply, within a range of 85 to 264 V for single-phase, or 360 to 550 V for
3-phase. Conforming to IEC standards and UL and CSA certified, they are suitable
for universal use. The inclusion of overload and short-circuit protection makes
downstream protection unnecessary if discrimination is not required.
ABL-7 RE and ABL-7 RP supplies are also equipped with an output undervoltage
control which causes the product to trip if the output voltage drops below 19 V, in
order to ensure that the voltage delivered is always usable by the actuators being
supplied. All the products are fitted with an output voltage adjustment potentiometer
in order to be able to compensate for any line voltage drops in installations with long
cable runs. Most of our power supplies are designed for direct mounting on 35 and
75 mm 7 rails.
108700-13-M
These power supplies are available in single-phase and 3-phase versions and are
split into three families:
Compact single-phase supply ABL-7CEM:
b power less than or equal to 30 W (1.2 A),
b compact size,
b for all low power equipment,
b suitable for use in automation system environments based on the Nano and Twido
platforms, or in any automation system configuration requiring a c 24 V supply.
ABL 7CEM
43367-15-M
ABL-7RP
Characteristics :
pages 2/56 to 2/59
References :
page 2/61
Dimensions :
page 2/62
Schemes :
page 2/63
2/52
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation (continued)
530894
108387-25-M
ABL-7UPS
ABL-7REQ
2.3
Using c 24 V
b Using c 24 V enables so-called protection installations (PELV) to be built. Using
PELV is a measure designed to protect people from direct and indirect contact.
Measures relating to these installations are defined in publication NF C 12-201 and
in standard IEC 364-4-41.
b The application of these measures to the electrical equipment in machines is
defined in standard NF EN 60204-1 and requires:
v that the voltage used is below 60 V d.c. in dry environments and below 30 V in
damp environments,
v the connection of one side of the PELV circuit, or one point of the source, to the
equipotential protection circuit associated with higher voltages,
v the use of switchgear and control gear on which measures have been taken to
ensure "safety separation" between power circuits and control circuits.
b A safety separation is necessary between power circuits and control circuits in
PELV circuits. Its aim is to prevent the appearance of dangerous voltages in c 24 V
safety circuits.
b The reference standards involved are:
v IEC 61558-2-6 and EN 61558-2-6 (safety transformers),
v IEC 664 (coordination of isolation).
Telemecanique power supplies meet these requirements.
b Moreover, to ensure that these products will operate correctly in relation to the
demands of their reinforced isolation, it is recommended that they be mounted and
wired as indicated below:
v they should be placed on an earthed mounting plate or rail,
v they should be connected using flexible cables, with a maximum of two wires per
connection, and tightened to the nominal torque,
v conductors of the correct insulation class must be used.
b If the d.c. circuit is not connected to an equipotential protection conductor, an
earth leakage detector will indicate any accidental earth faults (please consult your
Regional Sales Office).
Operating voltage
b The permissible tolerances for the operating voltage are listed in publications
IEC 1131-2 and DIN 19240.
b For nominal voltage Un = c 24 V, the extreme operating values are from - 15 %
to + 20 % of Un, whatever the supply fluctuations in the range -10 % to + 6 %
(defined by standard IEC 38) and load variations in the range 0-100 % of In.
All Telemecanique c 24 V power supplies are designed to provide a voltage within
this range.
b It may be necessary to use a voltage measurement relay to detect when the
normal voltage limits are being surpassed and to deal with the consequences of this
(please consult your Regional Sales Office).
Characteristics :
pages 2/56 to 2/59
References :
page 2/61
Dimensions :
page 2/62
Schemes :
page 2/63
2/53
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection
2.3
b Electromagnetic compatibility
Levels of conducted and radiated emissions are defined in standards EN 55011 and
EN 55022.
The majority of products in the Phaseo range have class B certification and can be
used without any restrictions due to their low emissions.
ABL-7CEM24003 and ABL-7CEM24006 power supplies have class A certification. It
is recommended that they should not be used in the following equipment: trains,
aircraft, nuclear applications and in any environment where malfunctioning could
cause serious injuries or lead to death. These products are designed for use in
industrial equipment and are not suitable for use in residential environments.
b Behaviour in the event of short-circuits
Phaseo power supplies are equipped with an electronic protection device. This
protection device resets itself automatically on elimination the fault (around 1 second
for ABL-7 RE/RP, around 3 seconds for ABL-7 UE/UP/REQ) which avoids having to
take any action or change a fuse. In addition, the Phaseo ABL-7RP/U/REQ ranges
allow the user to select the reset mode in the event of a fault:
- in the "AUTO" position, resetting is automatic,
- in the "MANU" position, resetting occurs after elimination of the fault and after
switching the mains power off and back on.
This feature allows Phaseo ABL-7RP/U/REQ power supplies to be used in
installations where the risks associated with untimely restarting are significant.
b Behaviour in the event of phase failure
In the event of failure of one phase, all Phaseo 3-phase power supplies switch to
relaxation mode for as long as the input voltage is < 450 V.
For operation on higher voltages (e.g. 480 V), use of an upstream GV2 type residual
current protection device is recommended.
b Selection of reset mode
v on the ABL-7RP family of products:
By microswitch on the front panel of the product.
v on the ABL-7U/REQ family of products:
By jumper on the front panel. Warning: selection of the function is only possible
after the mains power supply has been switched off for at least 5 minutes. The
jumper is moved using a pair of insulated, flat-nose pliers.
Presentation :
pages 2/52 and 2/53
Characteristics
pages 2/56 to 2/59
References :
page 2/61
Dimensions :
page 2/62
Schemes :
page 2/63
2/54
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection (continued)
Permissible variation
Output voltage
Output current
Single-phase
2-phase
a 100240 V 50/60 Hz
c 110 220 V (1)
Wide range
85264 V, 4763 Hz
c 100...250 V (1), c 105...370 V (2)
100240 V
50/60 Hz
Wide range
85264 V
4763 Hz
2 x 380415 V 3 x
50/60 Hz
380415 V
50/60 Hz
340460 V
340460 V
4763 Hz
4763 Hz
3 x 400520 V
50/60 Hz
Wide range
360550 V
4763 Hz
3 x 380520 V
50/60 Hz
Wide range
340550 V
4763 Hz
12 V
24 V
24 V
24 V
24 V
48 V
0.3 A
24 V
24 V
ABL7CEM24003
ABL7CEM24006
ABL7CEM24012
0.6 A
1.2 A
2A
ABL7RE2402
2.5 A
ABL7RP4803
3A
5A
3-phase
ABL7RP1205
10 A
ABL7RP2403
ABL7RP2405
ABL7RP2410
ABL7RE2403
ABL7RE2405
ABL7RE2410
ABL7REQ24050
ABL7REQ24100
2.3
20 A
ABL7UES24050
ABL7UEQ24100
ABL7UEQ24200
ABL7UPS24100
ABL7UPS24200
ABL7UPS24400
40 A
Conforming to EN 61000-3-2
No
No
No
Integrated automatic
protection
Yes
Automatic or manual restart on ABL-7RP
Automatic restart only on ABL-7CEM
Yes
Automatic
restart
Yes
Automatic or manual restart
No
Yes
(1) Values for ABL-7RP power supplies, not indicated on the product.
(2) Values for ABL-7CEM power supplies, not indicated on the product.
Presentation :
pages 2/52 and 2/53
Characteristics :
pages 2/56 to 2/59
References :
page 2/61
Dimensions :
page 2/62 and 2/63
Schemes :
page 2/63
2/55
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
Technical characteristics
Type of power supply
Product certifications
Conforming to standards
Safety
EMC
Low frequency harmonic currents
ABL-7CEM
cULus, TV
UL 508
IEC/EN 60950
EN 50081-2, EN 50082-2
ABL-7RE
UL, CSA, TV, CTick
UL 508, CSA 22.2 n 950
a 100240,
c 110220 compatible (1)
a 85264,
c 105370 compatible (1)
4763
> 70 %
0.1 (7 W)/0.2 (15 W)/0.45
(30 W)
0.17 (7 W)/0.3 (15 W)/0.68
(30 W)
< 50
0.45 approx.
Orange LED
a 100240
Green LED
c 24
0.3/0.6/1.2
Adjustable from 90 to 110 %
2 % max
< 200 (peak-peak)
> 20
See curves page 2/59
Permanent/automatic
restart
Green LED
1.05 In
U > 1.2
1.1 In
Tripping if U > 1.5 Un
Tripping if U < 0.8 Un
ABL-7RP
IEC/EN 61496-1-2
EN 50081-1, IEC 61000-6-2 (EN 50082-2)
EN 61000-3-2
Input circuit
2.3
LED indication
Input voltages
Rated values
Permissible values
Permissible frequencies
Efficiency at nominal load
Current
Ue = 240 V
consumption
Ue = 100 V
Hz
Current at switch-on
Power factor
A
A
a 85264 single-phase
> 85 %
0.6 (48 W)/0.83 (72 W)
1.2 (120 W)/2.5 (240 W)
1.2 (48 W)/1.46 (72 W)
1.9 (120 W)/3.6 (240 W)
< 30
0.65 approx.
Orange LED
a 100240,
c 110220 compatible (1)
a 85264,
c 100250 compatible (1)
Output circuit
LED indication
Nominal output voltage (U out)
Nominal output current
Precision
Output voltage
Line and load regulation
Residual ripple - interference
Micro-breaks
Holding time at I max and Ve min
Temporary overloads Permissible inrush current (U out >19V)
Protection
Short-circuit
V
A
mV
ms
Overload
Overvoltage
Undervoltage
Green LED
12, 24 and 48
2/3/5/10
2.5/5/10
Adjustable from 100 to 120 %
3%
> 10
> 20
Permanent/automatic
restart
Permanent/automatic
restart or restart after
switching off mains power
Input
Output
Storage temperature
Operating temperature
MTBF at 40
Connections
Series
Parallel
Dielectric strength
Input/output
Input/earth
Output/earth (and output/output)
Input fuse incorporated
Disturbance
Conducted
Radiated
Immunity
Electrostatic discharge
Electromagnetic
Conducted interference
Mains interference
Presentation :
pages 2/52 and 2/53
References :
page 2/61
mm2
mm2
C
C
2 x 2.5 + earth
2 x 2.5
2 x 2.5 + earth, multiple output, depending on model
- 25 + 70
- 10 + 60 (derating as
0 + 60 (derating as from 50 C, mounted vertically)
from 50 C, mounted
vertically)
2090 %
95 % without condensation or dripping water
IP 20 conforming to IEC 529
Conforming to IEC 61131-2
Vertical and horizontal
Vertical
(see derating curve,
page 2/58)
> 100 000 h
Possible (see page 2/59)
No
Possible (max. temperature 50 C)
3000 V/50 and 60 Hz 1 min 3000 V/50 and 60 Hz 1 min
2000 V/50 and 60 Hz 1 min 3000 V/50 and 60 Hz 1 min
500 V/50 and 60 Hz 1 min 500 V/50 and 60 Hz 1 min
Yes (not interchangeable)
EN 50081-2 (generic)
EN 50081-1
EN 55011/EN 55022 class A EN 55011/EN 55022 class B
(7 and 15 W) EN 55011/EN
55022 class B (30W)
EN 55011/EN 55022 class B
IEC 61000-6-2 (generic)
EN 61000-4-2 (4 kV contact/8 kV air)
EN 61000-4-3 level 3 (10 V/m)
EN 61000-4-4 level 3 (2 kV) , EN 61000-4-5, EN 61000-4-6 level 3, EN 61000-4-8 level 4
EN 1000-4-11 (voltage drops and cuts)
(1) Compatible input voltage, not indicated on the product.
Dimensions :
page 2/62
Schemes :
page 2/63
2/56
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics (continued)
Technical characteristics
Type of power supply
Product certifications
Conforming to standards
Safety
EMC
Low frequency harmonic currents
ABL-7REQ24p
ABL-7UEQ24p
ABL-7UES24p
EN 60950
EN 50081-1, EN 50082-2
ABL-7UPS24p
cULus, c us
EN 61000-3-2
Input circuit
LED indication
Input voltages
Rated values
Permissible values
Permissible frequencies
Efficiency at nominal load
Current consumption
Ue = 400 V
Current at switch-on
Power factor
2-phase operating mode
V
V
Hz
V
A
Green LED
c 24
5/10
mV
ms
15
a 3 x 400520
a 3 x 360550
Output circuit
LED indication
Nominal output voltage (U out)
Nominal output current
Precision
Output voltage
Line and load regulation
Residual ripple - interference
Micro-breaks
Holding time for I max and Ve min
Temporary overloads
Permissible inrush current (U out >19V)
Protection
Short-circuit
Overload
Overvoltage
Undervoltage
2.3
10/20
10
10/20/40
Between 8 and 13
V
V
Input
Output
Ambient
conditions
Storage temperature
Operating temperature
Maximum relative humidity
Degree of protection
Vibrations
Operating position
MTBF
Connections
Series
Parallel
Dielectric
strength
Input/output
Input/earth
Output/earth (and output/output)
Input fuse incorporated
Disturbance
Conducted/radiated
Immunity
Electrostatic discharge
Electromagnetic
Conducted interference
Mains interference
Presentation :
pages 2/52 and 2/53
References :
page 2/61
mm2
mm2
C
C
- 25+ 70
0 C+ 60 C
3090 %
IP 20 or IP XXB
Conforming to IEC 61131-2
Vertical
> 100 000 h
Possible
See page 2/58
4 x 1.52.5 mm2
Dimensions :
page 2/62
Schemes :
page 2/63
2/57
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Output characteristics
Derating
The ambient temperature is a determining factor which limits the power that an
electronic power supply can deliver continuously. If the temperature around the
electronic components is too high, their life will be significantly reduced. Conversely,
a power supply can deliver more than its nominal power if the ambient temperature
remains largely below the rated operating temperature.
The rated ambient temperature for Phaseo power supplies is 50 C. Above this,
derating is necessary up to a maximum temperature of 60 C.
The graph below shows the power (in relation to the nominal power) which the power
supply can deliver continuously, according to the ambient temperature.
P/Pn (%)
140
120
100
80
2.3
60
50
40
20
0
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
In all cases, there must be adequate convection round the products to ensure easier
cooling. There must be a clear space of 50 mm above and below Phaseo power
supplies and of 15 mm at the sides.
Presentation :
pages 2/52 and 2/53
References :
page 2/61
Dimensions :
page 2/62
Schemes :
page 2/63
2/58
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Output characteristics
(continued)
Load limit
ABL-7CEM24ppp
ABL-7RE24pp/ABL-7RPpppp
ABL-7Upp24pp/ABL-7REQpppp
U out (%)
U out
100 %
19 V
50 %
I out
In
I out
1,1 x In 1,2 x In
1,2 x In
1 ABL-7RE24pp/ABL-7RPpppp
2 ABL-7Upp24pp/ABL-7REQpppp
Temporary overloads
ABL-7CEM
ABL-7RE/ABL-7RP
I out
T (ms)
100
90
I out
T (ms)
20
I out:(0...100%)
I out:(0...100%)
2.3
18
80
70
16
60
50
14
40
12
30
20
10
10
0
0
1,8
2,2
2,4
1,2
2,6
x In
1,3
1,4
1,5
1,6
1,7
1,8
x In
ABL-7U
T (ms)
800
700
600
I out=0%
I out=50%
500
400
300
250
200
I out=80%
I out=100%
100
0
1,2
1,3
1,4
1,5
1,6
1,7
1,8
x In
(1)
ABL 7
ABL 7
ABL 7
ABL 7
Parallel connection
Series connection
(1)
2 x c 24 V / I out
Family
c 24 V / 2 x I out
Series
Parallel
ABL-7CEM
No
ABL-7RE/RP
2 products max
2 products max
ABL-7U/REQ
2 products max
2 products max
References :
page 2/61
Dimensions :
page 2/62
Schemes :
page 2/63
2/59
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection
ABL-7CEM, ABL-7RE and ABL-7RP power supplies: protection of the power supply line
Type of mains supply
Type of protection
2.3
a 115 V single-phase
Thermal-magnetic circuit-breaker
GB2
C60N
ABL-7CEM24003
GB2-CD06
ABL-7CEM24006
GB2-CD07
ABL-7CEM24012
GB2-CD07
ABL-7RE2402
GB2-pB07
24183
MG24516 (1)
24184
MG24517 (1)
24184
MG24517 (1)
MG24517 (1)
ABL-7RE2403
GB2-pB07
ABL-7RE2405
a 230 V single-phase
gG fuse
Thermal-magnetic circuit-breaker
gG fuse
GB2
C60N
2A
GB2-CD07
2A
2A
GB2-CD08
2A
GB2-CD08
2A
GB2-DB06
24184
MG24517 (1)
24185
MG24518 (1)
24185
MG24518 (1)
MG24516 (1)
MG24517 (1)
2A
GB2-DB06
MG24516 (1)
2A
GB2-pB08
MG24518 (1)
4A
GB2-DB07
MG17453 (1)
2A
ABL-7RE2410
GB2-pB12
MG17454 (1)
6A
GB2-DB08
MG24518 (1)
4A
ABL-7RP2403
GB2-pB07
MG24517 (1)
2A
GB2-DB07
MG24516 (1)
2A
ABL-7RP2405
GB2-pB07
MG24517 (1)
2A
GB2-DB07
MG24516 (1)
2A
ABL-7RP2410
GB2-pB09
MG24519 (1)
4A
GB2-DB07
MG24516 (1)
2A
ABL-7RP4803
GB2-pB07
MG24517 (1)
2A
GB2-DB07
MG24516 (1)
2A
2A
2A
2A
a 400 V 2-phase
Thermal-magnetic circuit-breaker
2-pole
gG fuse
GB2-DBpp
C60N
ABL-7REQ24050
DB07
24100
10 A
ABL-7REQ24100
DB08
24100
10 A
ABL-7UEQ, ABL-7UES and ABL-7UPS power supplies: protection of the power supply line
Type of mains supply
Type of protection
a 400480 V 3-phase
Thermal-magnetic circuit-breaker
2-pole
gG fuse
GV2-MEpp
C60N
ABL-7UEQ24100
GV2-ME08 (1)
24212
4A
ABL-7UEQ24200
GV2-ME08 (1)
24213
6A
ABL-7UES24050
GV2-ME08 (1)
24210
2A
ABL-7UPS24100
GV2-ME08 (1)
24210
2A
ABL-7UPS24200
GV2-ME08 (1)
24211
3A
ABL-7UPS24400
GV2-ME08 (1)
24212
4A
Presentation :
pages 2/52 and 2/53
References :
page 2/61
Dimensions :
page 2/62
Schemes :
page 2/63
2/60
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
108700-13-M
Mains
input voltage
47...63 Hz
V
ABL-7CEM
Output Nominal
voltage power
Nominal
current
c V
0.3
auto
no
ABL-7CEM24003
0.150
15
0.6
auto
no
ABL-7CEM24006
0.180
30
1.2
auto
no
ABL-7CEM24012
0.220
a 100240
24
single-phase
wide range
c 110220 (1)
Autoprotect
reset
Conforming Reference
to standard
EN 61000-3-2
Weight
kg
43367-15-M
Mains
input voltage
47...63 Hz
V
a 100240
single-phase
wide range
Output Nominal
voltage power
Nominal
current
Autoprotect
reset
Conforming Reference
to standard
EN 61000-3-2
Weight
c V
24
48
auto
no
ABL-7RE2402
0.520
72
auto
no
ABL-7RE2403
0.520
120
auto
no
ABL-7RE2405
1.000
240
10
auto
no
ABL-7RE2410
2.200
kg
2.3
Mains
input voltage
47...63 Hz
V
530894
a 100...240
single-phase
wide range
c 110...220 (1)
Nominal
current
c V
12
60
auto/man
yes
ABL-7RP1205
1.000
24
72
auto/man
yes
ABL-7RP2403
0.520
120
auto/man
yes
ABL-7RP2405
1.000
240
10
auto/man
yes
ABL-7RP2410
2.200
144
2.5
auto/man
yes
ABL-7RP4803
1.000
48
Autoprotect
reset
Conforming Reference
to standard
EN 61000-3-2
Weight
kg
ABL-7REQ
Output Nominal
voltage power
a 380415
Output Nominal
voltage power
Nominal
current
Autoprotect
reset
Conforming Reference
to standard
EN 61000-3-2
Weight
c V
24
120
auto/man
no
ABL-7REQ24050
0.850
240
10
auto/man
no
ABL-7REQ24100
1.200
kg
Mains
input voltage
47...63 Hz
V
Output Nominal
voltage power
Nominal
current
c V
24
240
10
auto/man
no
ABL-7UEQ24100
1.200
480
20
auto/man
no
ABL-7UEQ24200
2.100
120
auto/man
no
ABL-7UES24050
1.300
240
10
auto/man
yes
ABL-7UPS24100
1.300
480
20
auto/man
yes
ABL-7UPS24200
2.300
960
40
auto/man
(1) Compatible input voltage, not indicated on the product.
yes
ABL-7UPS24400
4.500
Characteristics :
pages 2/56 to 2/59
Schemes :
page 2/63
a 3x380415
a 3x400520
24
ABL-7UPS
Presentation :
pages 2/52 and 2/53
Dimensions :
page 2/62
Autoprotect
reset
Conforming Reference
to standard
EN 61000-3-2
Weight
kg
2/61
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Dimensions
ABL-7RE2405
ABL-7RP1205/2405/4803
120
120
27
ABL-7CEM24ppp
ABL-7CEM24003
ABL-7RE2410
ABL-7RP2410
120
ABL-7RE2402/2403
ABL-7RP2403
120
ABL-7RE24pp/ABL-7RPpppp
Common side view
Mounting on 35 and 75 mm rails
54
ABL-7CEM24006/
ABL-7CEM24012
135
ABL-7REQ24ppp/ABL-7UEQ24100/ABL-7UES24050/
ABL-7UPS24100
120
75
127
70
2.3
95
45
a
68
Panel mounting
(1)
60
(62,5)
ABL-
P
mm
130
154
154
171
171
7REQ24050
7REQ24100
7UEQ24100
7UES24050
7UPS24100
35 (38,5)
(1) 2 x M4 or 2 x 4.5
ABL-7UEQ24200
a
mm
15
15
ABL-7UPS24200
201
84
240
209
170
197
60
84
ABL-7UPS24400
230
242
81
106
275
Presentation:
pages 2/52 and 2/53
Characteristics:
pages 2/56 to 2/59
References:
page 2/61
Schemes:
page 2/63
2/62
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Schemes
ABL-7RE2410
L
ABL-7RE2405
ABL-7RE2402/2403
Filter
+
L/+
N/
N/
ABL-7RP2410
L/+
ABL-7RP1205/2405/4803
L/+
N/
ABL-7RP2403
Filter
Filter
2.3
NC
ABL-7CEM24ppp
ABL-7REQ24ppp
ABL-7UEppppp
+
+
+
+
L1
L2
+
+
L1
Presentation:
ABL-7UPppppp
L2
L3
L3
Characteristics:
pages 2/56 to 2/59
References:
page 2/61
Dimensions:
page 2/62
2/63
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
3/0
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Contents
3 - Application-specific modules
3/1
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection guide
Integrated
analogue
inputs/outputs
Analogue inputs
3
3.1
Type on inputs/outputs
Type
Voltage
Current
Voltage
Current
Multirange
Range
0...10 V
0...20 mA
4...20 mA
10 V
0...10 V
0...20 mA
4...20 mA
B, E, J, K, L, N, R, S,
T,U, Pt 100 , Ni 1000
(2 or 4 wire)
10 V,
0...10,V,1...5V
0...20 mA,4...20 mA
(external shunt
supplied))
Modularity
8 input channels
1 output channel
Isolation
8 channels
4 channels
Between channels
Common point
Common point
a 1000 V rms.
c 30 V (differential
channels)
a 500 V rms.
Common point
a 1000 V rms.
a 500 V rms.
Acquisition time
520 ms
Inputs
User-definable
filtering 0...66.3 s
Outputs
50 s
Resolution
8 bits
11 bits + sign
Connection
Type of modules
1 I/O analogue
inputs integrated
in TSX 37 22
Pages
3/4
3/9
Response time
12 bits
16 bits
3/2
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Analogue outputs
Analogue inputs/outputs
3
Voltage outputs
Voltage outputs/current
Voltage
Voltage
Current
Voltage
Current
Voltage
Current
10 V
10 V
0...20 mA
4...20 mA
10 V
0...10 V
0...20 mA
4...20 mA
10 V
0...10 V
0...20 mA
4...20 mA
4 channels
2 channels
4 inputs/2 outputs
Common point
a 1000 V rms.
a 1500 V rms.
a 1000 V rms.
a 1500 V rms.
a 1000 V rms.
a 2000 V rms.
16 ms (normal scan),
4 ms per channel used (fast scan)
11 bits,
+ sign (with range 10 V)
400 s
11 bits + sign
3.1
300 s
400 s
11 bits
3/9
3/3
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description
Description
TSX AEZ/ASZ/AMZ analogue I/O modules
1
3.1
2
3
4
TSX 37 22
TSX ACZ 03
2
3
Connection principle for integrated analogue channels using the Telefast 2 pre-wired system
Drive
TSX 37 22
TSX CCP S15
ABE 7CPA01
Functions:
pages 3/5 and 3/6
Characteristics:
pages 3/7 and 3/8
References:
page 3/9
3/4
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions
3
3.1
Presentation, description:
page 3/4
Characteristics:
pages 3/7 and 3/8
References:
page 3/9
3/5
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions (continued)
3.1
TSX Micro
It is possible to link the TSX STZ 10 I/O extension module (installed in position 4
of the base) to up to 3 high level Nano analogue I/O modules (3 input
channels/1output channel per module).
Length 200m
Presentation, description:
page 3/4
Characteristics:
pages 3/7 and 3/8
(1) Requires a PLC with a version u 5.0 operating system. Installation of the TSX AMZ 600
involves version u 4.2 PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro software.
References:
page 3/9
3/6
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
Input ranges
V rms
V rms
10 V
020 mA
Thermocouples, temperature probes, high
010 V
4...20 mA
level (see range below)
11 + sign
12
16
32
520
4 x No. of channels used
V
mA
Common point
30
See page 6/4
Analogue/digital conversion
Acquisition period
Normal cycle
Fast cycle
Measurement filtering
Hardware filtering
1st order
Maximum error
At 25 C
0...60 C
Maximum temperature drift
Input independence
Isolation
Betw. chann. and bus
Betw. chann. and
earth
Betw. channels
Maximum excess -voltage on inputs
Consumption
bits
ms
ms
% FS
% FS
%/10 C
c 30 V (differential inputs)
30
7.5
3.1
At 25 C
0...60 C
% FS
% FS
At 25 C
0...60 C
C
C
At 25 C
0...60 C
Ext. c.
Int. c.
Ext. c.
Int. c.
C
C
C
C
10 V
0...10 V
0.03
0.03
0.30
0.30
Pt 1000
0.7 + 7.9 10-4 x M (2)
1.7 + 37.5 10-4 x M (2)
B
E
3.6
1.3
3.6
3.8
19.1
4.5
19.1
5.5
0...5 V
0.04
0.33
Ni 1000
0.2
0.7
J
1.6
4.6
5.4
6.9
1...5 V
0.06
0.40
020 mA 420 mA
0.18
0.22
0.47
0.59
K
1.7
4.8
6.4
7.7
L
1.6
4.6
5.2
6.8
N
1.5
3.7
6.1
7
R
2.6
4.2
14.1
14.5
S
2.9
4.6
16.2
16.6
T
1.6
4.6
5.5
7.1
U
1.3
3.8
4.7
5.9
Presentation, description:
page 3/4
Functions:
pages 3/5 and 3/6
bits
s
K
% FS
% FS
V
%/10 C
V rms
V rms
0.083
1500
1500
Common point
See page 6/4
(1) Cut-off frequency # 10.8 kHz (temperature probes), # 255 Hz (high level).
(2) Precise measurements are given as a function of measurement M for 4-wire temperature
probe cabling.
(3) Ext. c: with external cold junction compensation; Int. c: with internal cold junction
compensation.
References:
page 3/9
3/7
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics (continued)
Number of channels
Input ranges
Analogue/digital conversion
Resolution
Acquisition period
Measurement filtering
Hardware filtering
bits
Normal cycle
Fast cycle
ms
ms
1st order
4
10 V
0...10 V
0...20 mA
11 + sign
11
11
4...20 mA
11 (from 0 to
20 mA)
12 A (1900 pts) 12 A (1500 pts)
32
Maximum error
At 25 C
% FS
0.10 (10mV)
0.15 (30 A)
0.15 (20 A)
0...60 C
% FS
%/10 C
0.40 (80 A)
0.054
250
0.40 (80 A)
V rms
V rms
V
mA
Common point
30
See page 6/4
Temperature drift
Input impedance
Isolation
3.1
Integrated in the
TSX 37-22
8
0...10 V
020 mA/
420 mA (1)
8
7.5
Cut-off freq.
# 600 Hz
Voltage Current
1.8
2.8
4
5.6
0.75
0.8
54 k
499 k
None
None (0 V w.r.t.
earth)
Common point
+30/-15 15
Number of channels
Output ranges
Analogue/digital conversion
Response time
Maximum resolution
Output load
Maximum error
bits
s
At 25 C
At 60 C
K
% FS
% FS
Type of protection
Maximum voltage without damage
Maximum temperature drift
Isolation
%/10 C
Betw. chann. and bus V rms
Betw. chann. and
V rms
earth
Betw. channels
Consumption
2
10 V
11 + sign
0...10 V
11
At 25 C
At 60 C
mA
mV
mV
%/10 C
4...20 mA
11 (from 0 to
20 mA)
400
6 mV (3800 pts) 6 mV (1900 pts)
> 2 (10 mA max)
0.5 (50 mV)
0.58 (58 mV)
Permanent short-circuit
30
7.5
0.083
1000
0.107
1000
Common point
See page 6/4
0...20 mA
11
Integrated in:
TSX 37-22
1
0...10 V
8
50
40 mV
>5
1.5
3
Permanent
short-circuit
Short-circuit on
0 V or on 5 V
0.5
None
None (0 V w.r.t.
earth)
(2)
10
390
600
1
Permanent
short-circuit
(1) With the TSX ACZ 03 adjustment/adaptor module. For specifications of 8 c 24 V discrete
inputs, see page 1/9.
(2) Output for a maximum of 4 adjustment potentiometers (internal or external).
Presentation, description:
page 3/4
Functions:
pages 3/5 and 3/6
References:
page 3/9
3/8
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Number of
channels
8
Isolated high
4
level analogue
thermocouples,
temperature
probes
Resolution
Reference
(1)
TSX AEZ 801
Weight
kg
0.200
10 V, 010 V
11 bits
+ signal
12 bits
0.200
10 V, 010 V,
16 bits
05 V, 15 V, 020 mA,
420 mA, B, E, J, K, L, N, R, S,
T, U, Pt 100, Ni 1000 (2 or 4-wire)
0.210
Reference
(1)
TSX ASZ 401
Weight
kg
0.200
0.200
10 V,
020 mA, 420 mA
Resolution
11 bits
+ signal
11 bits
+ signal
or 12 bits
3.1
Range of I/O
Resolution
11 bits +
signal
or 12 bits
Reference
(1)
TSX AMZ 600
Weight
kg
0.240
Reference
Weight
kg
0.075
ABE 7CPA01
Type of outputs
Use
Functions performed
Adaptation
module
SUB-D type
connectors
(lots of 2)
TSX 37 22 integrated
15-pin SUB-D type
analogue and counter I/O connector
channels
Telefast 2
Integrated analogue I/O
connection base channels TSX 37 22
Description
Cable (section
0.205 mm 2)
For connection
From
Integrated analogue I/O
(15-pin SUB-D type
connector)
to
Base ABE 7CPA01
(15- pin SUB-D type
connector)
0.050
ABE 7CPA01
0.300
Length Reference
m
(1)
0.5
1
2.5
Weight
kg
0.110
0.160
0.300
Replacement parts
TSX CCP S15
Description
Connection
terminal block
Presentation, description:
page 3/4
Functions performed
Reference
Batch of 4
Adaptation for 250 0.1 % current range for TSX AEZ 414 TSX AAK2
resistors
module
(supplied with
module
TSX AEZ 4 14)
(1) Product supplied with TSX BLZ H01 screw connection terminal block.
Functions:
pages 3/5 and 3/6
Weight
kg
0.060
0.020
Characteristics:
pages 3/7 and 3/8
3/9
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
fonctions
Presentation
The CCX 17 industrial operator panel displays and controls all the PID controller
parameters which can be modified without having to program the TSX Micro or
Premium PLC application program.
The PID_MMI man-machine interface function, included in the PL7 Junior software,
provides an application program on the CCX 17 industrial operator panel for
controlling and adjusting PID loops.
It enables the CCX 17 operator panel to manage:
b Selection of a PID loop.
b Display and control of that PID loop.
b Adjustment of the PID loop parameters.
This man-machine interface function is easily installed for any man-machine
interface application on the CCX 17 operator panel. The three preconfigured screens
enable the required operations to be performed on any PID controller.
3.1
Output
Analog control
OutputUP
Discrete servo
control
Inputs
420 mA
SERVO
PID
Measure
KP
TI
TD
Output DOWN
Thermocouple
Setpoint
Controller
Input position
feedback
Probe
PWM
Output
Discrete control
PWM
The PID function sets a PID serial/parallel algorithm and works out the control signal
on the basis of:
b A measurement sampled by an input module.
b The setpoint value fixed either by the operator or by the program.
b The values of the various controller parameters (KP, TI, TD, sampling period, etc).
The analogue control signal from the controller can be processed:
b Either directly by a TSX Micro or Premium PLC analogue output module
connected to the actuator.
b Or via the PWM or SERVO adaptations depending on the type of actuator for
discrete control.
The PWM function provides the required adaptation to control a pulse width
modulation actuator via a discrete output.
The SERVO function provides the required adaptation to control a motorised
actuator with UP/DOWN control provided by a discrete output. It has a position
feedback input to execute servo control.
These two functions are installed in cascade on the PID controller function.
Description:
page 3/12
Characteristics:
pages 3/11 and 3/12
References:
page 3/13
3/10
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions,
characteristics
AUTO
UP
DN
LIBELLE2
PV :
SP :
OUT :
SUP :
INF :
The PID_MMI man-machine interface function, included in the PL7 Junior software,
provides an application program on the CCX 17 industrial operator panel for
controlling and adjusting PID loops.
It enables the CCX 17 operator panel to manage:
b Selection of a PID loop.
b Display and control of that PID loop.
b Adjustment of the PID loop parameters.
This man-machine interface function is easily installed for any man-machine
interface application on the CCX 17 operator panel. The three preconfigured screens
enable the required operations to be performed on any PID controller.
The CCX 17 operator panel can manage up to 9 PID controllers. Installation of the
man-machine interface function is simple and is performed as follows:
b The PID_MMI function is activated on each scan of the TSX Micro or Premium
PLC (unconditional call-up).
b A single call-up of the PID_MMI function manages all the PID loops in the
TSX Micro or Premium PLC -application.
3
3.1
MOD
LIBELLE2
UP
DN
TI(s)
:
TS(s)
:
OUT_MAX :
KP
:
TD(s)
: Sa
PV_DEV :
OUT_MIN :
MOD
Characteristics
Function PID
Type
Maximum number
Sampling period
Operating mode
Measurement
Control
Proportional gain
Integral action
Derivative action
Execution time (ms)
Process control
PWM
functions with pulses
outputs
SERVO
No man-machine interface
Man-machine interface
Type
Modulation period
Execution time (ms)
Type
Operating mode
Presentation:
page 3/10
References:
page 3/13
3/11
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Description,
characteristics
1
3
3.1
4
2
6
4
5
Characteristics
Type of panels
Display
Protection
Temperature
Standard
Nb of characters per
line
Character size
mm
Number
Number
Number
Number
Number
Number
Number
PLCs
Printer
V
Number
Voltage
Current
Front view
Back view
Operating
Storage
Shock resistance
Vibration resistance
Certifications
Presentation:
page 3/10
T CCX 17 20 Lp
Back-lit LCD
4 single height, 2 double height
Type of screen
Number of lines
V
mA
C
C
T CCX 17 30 Lp
8 single height,
4 double height
References:
page 3/13
3/12
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References,
dimensions
T CCX 1720 Lp
Number
of keys
4
T CCX 1720 LW
Weight
Kg
1.450
Uni-Telway,
Fipio (2)
Yes
T CCX 1720 L
1.510
1.510
Uni-Telway
T CCX 1730 LW
1.470
Uni-Telway,
Fipio (2)
Yes
T CCX 1730 L
1.530
1.560
Separate parts
Description
Fipio Agent PCMCIA
card
T CCX 1730 Lp
Use
Capacity of Reference
memory
TSX FPP 10
64 Kwords
Weight
Kg
0.110
0.060
0.060
0.060
Flash EPROM memory Archive MMI applications 64 Kwords TSX MFP 064P
PCMCIA cards
128 Kwords TSX MFP 0128P
0.060
3
3.1
0.060
Connecting cables
Use
from
Uni-Telway
CCX 17 20/30
PCMCIA card
Longueur
to
TSX Micro and Premium 2.5 m
TER/AUX terminal port
5m
Reference
Weight
Kg
XTB Z968
0.180
XTB Z9681
0.340
1.8 m
XTB Z908
0.240
PC via adaptor
TSX SCA 72
Bus Fipio
3m
0.250
(1) Includes the T CCX CB 10 cable as standard (0.2 m long with 2 2x26-way and 25-way SUB-D
connectors). Includes a multilingual quick reference guide as standard (English, French,
German, Italian and Spanish).
(2) Includes the MMI application archive and retrieval function on a PCMCIA card.
(3) The CCX 17 operator panel connected on a Fipio bus communicates with the bus arbitrator
PLC station.
(4) Only compatible with MMI applications on T CCX 1720 ppp operator panels.
Dimensions, mounting
134
9
80
225
207
Presentation:
page 3/10
137 0,5
Flush-mounted
152
Dimensions
Description:
page 3/12
210 0,5
Fixed by 4 or 6 locking clips (supplied) pressure mounted (on panel 1 to 6 mm thick)
Characteristics:
pages 3/11 and 3/12
3/13
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection guide
Number of channels(1)
2 independant channels
Response time
Counter/measurement inputs
Auxiliary inputs
Counting capacity
Functions
Processing
Inputs :
Counter enable, counter present.
Comparison:
Downcounting: to value 0. Upcounting: 2 thresholds and 1setpoint. Up/down counting:
2 thresholds.
Events
Events associated with each counter channel, causing activation of the priority event-triggered task
Connection
Type of modules
1 Counter channels on
discrete inputs
2 Counter channels
integrated in TSX 37 22
3.2
Pages
3/16
(1) Max. 6 channels with TSX 37 05/08/10, 8 channels with TSX 37 21 and 9 channels with TSX 37 22 (see page 3/16).
3/14
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
1 channel
2 independant channels
40 kHz
1 channel
500 kHz
Per channel : c 5/24 V inputs for 1 Totem pole or RS 422 incremental encoder or for c 24 V proximity
sensors and mechanical contacts
2 x c 24 V input: capture
3.2
Inputs:
Counter enable, counter preset, capture current value
and 2 setpoints
Inputs:
2 capture inputs
- Comparison to the position value: 4 thressholds
causing activation of priority event-triggered task
crossing a threshold, crossing a setpoint, present done, enable done, capture done
TSX CTZ 1A
3/19
TSX CTZ 2A
TSX CTZ 1B
3/25
3/15
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description
Counter channels on
TSX 37 22
4
4
4
5
4
6
7
7
6
7
6
8
0
0
7
7
0
1
6
7
0
2
6
8
1
0
6
7
1
1
6
8
1
2
5
8
2
0
6
8
2
1
5
8
2
2
5
9
Description
Counting (500 Hz) on the inputs of discrete modules
The first 4 inputs of the TSX DEZ/DMZ pppp 28, 32 or 64 discrete I/O module
located in slot no. 1 enable two counter channels to be used.
3.2
1 20-way HE 10 connector (or screw terminal block depending on the model) for
connecting:
v Counter sensors or c 24 V incremental encoder for channel 0,
v Counter sensors for channel 1,
v c 24 V encoder power supply.
The second connector can take the Telefast 2 ABE 7CPA01 wiring system to
facilitate installation.
TSX CTZ 1A/2A (40 kHz) and TSX CTZ 2AA (500 kHz) counter modules
The TSX CTZ 1A (1 channel) and TSX CTZ 2A/2AA (2 channels) half-format counter
modules have on their front panel:
1
1
v
v
v
Specification:
page 3/17
Characteristics:
page 3/18
References:
page 3/19
Connections:
pages 3/20 and 3/21
Dimensions:
page 3/21
3/16
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Specifications
Counter
sensor
SM Operating direction
This example shows the grouping of objects supplied by a conveyor belt for
packaging.
This simple counting application uses a sensor (proximity sensor, photoelectric
sensor) linked to a preset counter. When the preset value is reached the packaging
command is activated and the control system initiates a new packaging cycle.
Counter
Time
Tunnel
Input sensor
SM Operating direction
3.2
Tunnel total
Max.
Mini
Alarm
Time
Pulse counter
This up/down counting application follows this sequence: a sensor detects the
presence of the object on the conveyor belt. While the object is on the belt, the pulses
from the generator linked to the forward movement of the conveyor belt are counted.
The number of pulses represents an image of the length of the object. This
measurement can then be compared to various minimum and maximum thresholds.
Pc
Presence of item
L max.
L mini
Item outside
range
Time
The speed of the pump is measured by taking account of the pulses supplied by an
incremental encoder (or proximity sensor) during a unit of time (time base worked out
by the TSX 37 22 PLC system).
The current value obtained is compared to the two predefined thresholds in order to
detect any anomaly.
Pc
V max.
V mini
Alarm
Description:
page 3/16
Time
Characteristics:
page 3/18
References:
page 3/19
Connections:
pages 3/20 and 3/21
Dimensions:
page 3/21
3/17
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
Configuration
parameters
Adjustment
parameters
Upcounting and/or
downcounting function with
processing:
- compare measurement at
2 thresholds and
2 setpoints
- event management
%Q, %QW
%I, %IW
Auxiliary inputs
processing
Discrete= sensor or
incremental encoder
signals
TSX DSZ
discrete output
module
Output 0
Output 1
IA
IB
(2)
per chan.
chan. 11
chan.12
per chan.
IZ
IPres
(2) (3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
IVal
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
IRead
CO
(3)
3.2
Counting functions are configured and installed using PL7 Micro or PL7 Junior
software (see page 5/11).
(2) Input IB can be defined by software configuration in input IPres.
(3) Software input possible.
Electrical characteristics
Type of counter module/channel
Number of channels
Frequency on counter inputs
kHz
Frequency limitation
Envent processing response time
Hz
ms
Processing response time in master task (scan time: ms
5 ms)
Sensor power supply monitoring
Voltage
V
Current
mA
Consumption
TSX CTZ 1A
1
40
TSX CTZ 2A
2
Integrated
TSX CTZ 2AA TSX 37 22
Discrete inputs/outputs
TSX DEZ/DMZ
c 24 V
a 100120 V
0.5/0.45 (4)
0.02
100, with c 24 V sensors with mechanical output (limit switches)
Taking account of an input and positioning of a discrete module output:
1.5
2
Taking account of an event-triggered input and positioning of a discrete module output: 8
500
y 2.5
y 0.5
See page 6/4
10
Counter inputs
TSX CTZ 1A/2A/2AA
Nominal values
Limit values
Voltage
Current
Voltage
At state 1
At state 0
Logic
Input impedance
Voltage
Current
V
mA
V
V
mA
Voltage
Current
V
mA
For nominal U
For U = 2.4 V RS 422
compatibility
Response time
(Immunite avec utilisation de contacts mecaniques)
Type of inputs
IEC 1131 conformity
Proximity sensor compatibility
Description:
page 3/16
Applications:
page 3/17
k
k
ms
c5
18
5.5
u 2.4
> 3.7 (U = 2.4 V)
(7)
y 1.2
< 1 (U = 1.2 V)
Positive
0.270
> 0.440
(U = 2.4 V) (8)
3
Integrated channels
c 24
Auxiliary inputs
TSX CTZ pp Integrated chan.
c5
3
1930 (6)
25.5
u 11
u 2.1
> 6 (U = 11 V) > 2 (U = 2.4 V)
c 24
8.7
7
1930
1930 (6)
u 11
> 6 (U = 11 V) > 6
y5
< 2 (U = 5 V)
y1
< 0.65
<5
<2
y5
<5
< 1.4
1.4
0.270
> 0.270
2.7
3.4
2.4
0.21
10
1930
> 2.5
Resistive
Current sink
Resistive
Type 2
Type 1
Type 2
2-wire/3-wire
2-wire/3-wire
(4) 0.45 kHz for an incremental encoder with phase-shifted signals.
(5) For characteristics of TSX DEZ/DMZ pppp discrete input modules, see page 2/8.
(6) Up to 34 V for 1 hr in 24 hours.
(7) For TSX CTZ 2AA module: > 6.8 mA (U = 3 V).
(8) For TSX CTZ 2AA module: > 0.350 k (U = 3V).
(9) For TSX CTZ 2AA module: < 25 s (state 0 to 1), < 50 s (state 1 to 0).
References:
page 3/19
Connections:
pages 3/20 and 3/21
Dimensions:
page 3/21
3/18
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
500 kHz
TSX CTZ 1A
ABE 7CPA01
ABE 7H16R20
Telefast 2 connection
sub-bases
Reference (1)
TSX CTZ 1A
Weight
kg
0.200
TSX CTZ 2A
0.210
0.220
Type of connectors/
connection to
High-density 15-way SUB-D
Weight
kg
0.050
15-way SUB-D
0.050
ABE 7CPA01
0.300
Auxiliary inputs
c 24 V power supply and
c 5 V/1030 V encoder power
supply
20-way HE 10
TSX CTZ 1 A Totem Pole
20-way HE 10
TSX CTZ 2A/2AA module
ABE 7H08R10
0.190
ABE 7H16R20
0.300
0.260
0.260
Reference
3.2
Connection cables
Description
Cable
(cross-section 0.205 mm2)
From
To
Length
Integrated counter
(15-way SUB-D connector)
ABE 7CPA01
sub-base (15-way
SUB-D connector)
0.5 m
Weight
kg
TSX CCP S15 050
0.110
1m
0.160
2.5 m
0.300
2.5 m
0.300
3m
0.400
5m
0.660
10 m
1.210
0.090
0.170
0.250
0.085
0.150
0.280
3m
0.410
5m
0.670
10 m
1.230
ABE 7H08R10/16R20 1 m
Telefast 2 sub-base
(20-way HE 10
2m
connector)
3m
Reference
Description:
page 3/16
Applications:
page 3/17
Characteristics:
page 3/18
Connections:
pages 3/20 and 3/21
Dimensions:
page 3/21
3/19
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connections
Encoder
power supply
+ +
TSX 37 22
5V
22
28
+ 24 V 26
0 V 27
c 24 V input power
supply
++
10...30 V
25
Telefast 2
23
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20
22
24
26
28
30
32
ABE 7CPA01
16
Channel 11
IPres12
Preset
20
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
19
21
23
25
27
29
31
GND
IPres11
Preset
+
14
IA 1
Channel 12
A
+
IA + 24 V 4
Counter sensor
GND
c 24 V input power
supply
++
28
+ 24 V 26
0 V 27
+ +
3.2
Telefast 2
23
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20
22
24
26
28
30
32
IB 10
NC
IB = 24 V
NC
0V
NC
+ 1030 V
2-wire proximity
sensor
IB + 24 V 8
Channel 11
NC
IB + 5 V
NC
0V
NC
+5V
IZ + 24 V 14
IA 1
IA + 24 V 4
+
IZ 16
ABE 7CPA01
1 Encoder
2 TSX TAP S15 05/24 connector
Preset
20
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
19
21
23
25
27
29
31
GND
IPres11
GND
+
++
PNP
6
8
9
10
11
203
102
11
202
12
14
15
100
13
101
14
16
15
200
17
18
19
+
IA
IB
12
10
13
FU1
103
104
205
204
6
PNP
200
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
105
C
C
C
C
300
301
302
303
304
305
306
307
308
309
310
311
312
313
314
315
4
5
1
2
3
4
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
Telefast 2
PNP
++
3
2
1
3/20
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connections (continued),
dimensions
++
28
+ 24 V 26
0 V 27
+ +
Telefast 2
Channel 0
Channel 0
Channel 1
Channel 1
EPSR 18
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20
22
24
26
28
30
32
0 V 25
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
19
21
23
25
27
29
31
GND
TSX CTZ pp
IZ 16
ABE 7CPA01
IZ + 24 V 14
IB 10
IB + 24 V 8
+
Channels 0 and 1
IA 1
A
+
IA + 24 V 4
GND
++
102
++
10...30 V
5V
100
Telefast 2
110
200
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
Read
Channel 1
C
C
C
C
300
301
302
303
304
305
306
307
308
309
310
311
312
313
314
315
210
ICapt1
1
2
3
4
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
NC
IB + 24 V
NC
0V
NC
+ 1030 V
Enable
209
108
IPres1
208
Preset
206
106
ICapt0
Channel 0
105
Read
Enable
IVal1
IVal0
205
104
Preset
3
4
5
6
NC
IB + 5 V
NC
4
NC
+5V
109
1 Encoder.
2 Connecteurs TSX TAP S15 05/24.
TSX TAP S15 05
1 IB 7
2 Sup.Ret. 8
3 IZ + 5V
9
4 IZ - 10
10
5 IA + 5 V 11
6 IA 12
3.2
101
IPres0
204
Dimensions
27,4
70,4
43
31
55
38
47
Description:
page 3/16
Applications:
page 3/17
Characteristics:
page 3/18
References:
page 3/19
3/21
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description,
operation
Presentation
The 1 channel TSX CTZ 1B positioning module completes the TSX Micro platform
range in the counting and positioning field through the acquisition of information from
a SSI series absolute encoder.
This type of module allows for the following and actual positioning of a moving object,
including after a loss of power. This characteristic, linked to the absolute encoder is
used to simplify the installation of positioning applications. It also simplifies the input
interfaces by suppressing homing, adjustment
Depending on the model, the TSX Micro PLCs can receive the maximum of:
b TSX 37 05/10, 2 TSX CTZ 1B modules in slots 3 and 4.
b TSX 37 08, 2 TSX CTZ 1B modules in slots 5 and 6.
b TSX 37 21/22, 4 TSX CTZ 1B modules in slots 3, 4, 5 and 6.
b and this within the limit of the number of channels generated by the
TSX Micro PLC (see page 3/16).
3
Description
The front panel of the TSX CTZ 1B half-size positioning module (1 channel) includes:
1
3.2
3
2
Operation
Functional synoptic of the positioning channel:
Configuration
and adjustment
%MW, %MDW
Configuration/adjustment
parameters
%I, %IW
Comparer 0
%Q, %QW
Comparer 1
Position
value
SSI link
Absolute
encoder input
Filter
Capture input 0
Comparer 2
Events
EVT
Comparer 3
Modulo
Event task
Capture
Capture input 1
Implementation of the TSX CTZ 1B requires the use of version u 4.2 of the PL7
Micro/Junior/Pro software. The TSX Micro PLC receiving the module should be
equipped with the operating system version u 5.0.
Characteristics:
page 3/23
References:
page 3/24
Connections:
page 3/25
3/22
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
TSX CTZ 1B
1
cV
Voltage
SSI absolute Number of bits
encoder
Frequency
Distance
Parallel
output
encoder (1)
5, 10...30
8 25 bits
kHz
200
1000
10 max. (encoder-module)
Number of bits
24
Voltage
24
mA
Voltage
> 11
Current
mA
> 3 (U = 11 V)
Voltage
<5
Current
mA
< 1.5
k ohms
0 to 1 state
< 50
1 to 0 state
< 50
At state 1
At state 0
Input impedance
Acceptance
time
Input type
Resistive
Type 1 sensor
3.2
Detector compatibility
Functions
Module type
Read frequency
TSX CTZ 1B
Depending on mode:
200 kHz in slow mode
1 MHz in fast mode
Comparative function
4 thresholds each linked to 1 maskable EVti event (activation upon event tasks) and to
1 position bit in relation to the (upper/lower) threshold
Capture/measure function
Modulo function
Offset function
Checks
Description:
page 3/22
References:
page 3/24
Connections:
page 3/25
3/23
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Specifications
Channel Reference
number
1
TSX CTZ 1B
Weight
kg
0.205
Add.
(2)
3
Weight
kg
0.050
Connection accessories
Designation
TSX CTZ 1B
ABE 7CPA01
Connector on
TSX CTZ 1B module
9-pin SUB-D type
0.050
Telefast 2
connection base
ABE 7CPA01
0.300
Telefast 2
adaptation base
ABE 7CPA11
0.300
From
To
Reference (1)
Weight
kg
0.300
SUB-D connectors
(batch of 2)
Reference
TSX CAP S9
3.2
Connection
Cable
length 2.5 m (0.205 mm2
section)
Add.
(2)
5
(1) Absolute encoder with parallel outputs and ABE 7CPA11 adaptation base. This base is used
to multiplex up to 4 absolute encoders on the encoder input of the TSX CTZ 1B module.
(2) Addresses, see page 3/21.
Description:
page 3/22
Characteristics:
page 3/23
Connections:
page 3/25
3/24
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connections
++
44
3
Capture input 0
Supply
c 24 V sensors
+ +
6
4
6
4
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20
22
24
26
28
30
32
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
19
21
23
25
27
29
31
GND
PNP
ABE-7CPA01
12
8
27
28
22
24
25
NPN
Capture input 1
c 10/30 V
12
8
27
28
22
24
25
c5V
3.2
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20
22
24
26
28
30
32
1
3
5
7
9
11
13
15
17
19
21
23
25
27
29
31
GND
+ +
ABE-7CPA11
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Description:
page 3/22
Characteristics:
page 3/23
References:
page 3/24
3/25
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
4/0
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Contents
4 - Communication
4/1
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection guide
Applications
Modbus Plus
10/100BASE-T (RJ45)
CSMA-CD
10/100 Mbit/s
Twisted pair
64
100 m max. between hub and terminal
device
1 max.
Structure
Physical interface
Access method
Rate
Medium
Configuration
Services
Nature of modules
Independent module
Type of modules
Pages
4/15
4/37
4/2
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Fipway
AS-Interface
Fip standard
Bus managed by bus arbitrator
ISO 11898
CSMA/CA, multi-master
10 Kbit/s...1 Mbit/s according to distance
127 slaves
From 20 m (1 Mbit/s)...2500 m (20 Kbit/s)
31 sensor/actuator devices
100 m
200 m with repeaters
CANopen :
- Implicit PDO exchange
- Explicit SDO exchange or CAN function block
- Explicit PDU CAN exchange
Uni-TE
COM/shared table
Application-to-application
Telegram
TSX FPP 20
TSX SAZ 10
4/49
4/25
4/27
4/3
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Applications
1
2
Modbus RTU
Fipio (agent)
Physical interface
Norme Fip
Access method
Rate
Slave
19,2 Kbit/s max.
Mdium
Configuration
Master/slave
28 devices max.
98 slave addresses
max.
Maximum length
No. of links/station
1 max.
Services
TSX 37-05/08/10
PLC bases
Nature of modules
Type of modules
Modbus
master/slave RTU
13 Modbus functions (read/write bits and
words, diagnostic)
TER
terminal port
Pages
4/40
Uni-TE
Periodic data exchange
Application-to-application
Transparent exchange of remote I/O
AUX
TSX FPP 10
terminal port
4/53
4/4
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
1
2
Uni-Telway
Character mode
RS 485 non-isolated
RS 485 isolated via TSX P ACC 01 tap
RS 232D
RS 485 isolated
20 mA CL
RS 232D
RS 485 isolated
RS 422
20 mA CL
Master/slave
19,2 Kbit/s max.
0,3...19,2 Kbit/s
1,2...19,2 Kbit/s
Point-to-point
Point-to-point in
RS 422
Multipoint in RS 485
Point-to-point
Multipoint
15 m
1000 m
1300 m
10 m non-isolated
1300 m isoled
Point-to-point
in RS 232D,
28 in RS 485,
16 in 20 mA CL
15 m in point-to-point
1000 m in RS 485
1300 m in 20 mA CL
1 max.
TSX 37-05/08/10
PLC bases
TER
terminal port
AUX
terminal port
(1)
4/63
4/65
(1) At the end of reference, replace p by 1: RS 232D, by 2: 20 mA CL or by 4: isolated RS 485.
4/5
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
TSX Micro platforms connect to the Ethernet TCP/IP network via 2 external and
autonomous TSX ETZ 410/510 modules. These modules are also used to link to an
external modem.
Ethernet TCP/IP TSX ETZ 410 module
The TSX ETZ 410 module includes:
b A Modbus/Uni-TE TCP/IP communication profile on Ethernet 10/100 Mbits/s or
TCP/IP via RS232 serial link connected to an external 56K bit/s modem.
b The integrated Web server function. The integrated Web server provides
access to:
v the module configuration,
v the PLC diagnostics system function, Rack Viewer,
v the communication diagnostics function,
v the access function to the PLC data and variables, Data Editor,
v and accepts the scanned input/output function; the TSX ETZ 410 can be scanned
by a device which supports the exchange of I/O Scanning input/outputs.
Ethernet TCP/IP TSX ETZ 510 module
The Ethernet TSX ETZ 510 uses all the functions of the TSX ETZ 410 module, and
in addition, the following functions on the level of the integrated Web server function.
4.1
Via the:
TSX 37 10/21/22 PLC terminal port (TER),
TSX 37 21/22 PLC auxiliary port (AUX),
TSX SCP114 serial link PCMCIA card inserted into the TSX 37 21/22 PLC.
b On a Uni-Telway bus, via the TSX SCA 50 derivation box or the TSX P ACC 01
isolation box.
The Ethernet TSX ETZ 410/510 modules are configured with the assistance of a
standard browser using:
b The Ethernet network.
b RS 232C serial link (PPP protocol).
The Ethernet TSX ETZ 410/510 modules ensure that the TSX Micro PLC TER port
is duplicated; the PLC connected to the TSX ETZ 410/510 module via this TER port
can be accessed locally by a programming terminal equipped with PL7 TSX Micro/
Junior/Pro software.
Functions:
pages 4/8 to 4/12
Description:
page 4/13
Characteristics:
page 4/14
References:
page 4/15
Dimensions:
page 4/15
4/6
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Structure
OSI model
Application
Uni-TE Modbus
Uni-TE Modbus
Presentation
Session
Transport
TCP
TCP
Network
IP
IP
Link
PPP
Physical
4
4.1
Functions:
pages 4/8 to 4/12
Description:
page 4/13
Characteristics:
page 4/14
References:
page 4/15
Dimensions:
page 4/15
4/7
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions
Ethernet link
PC + Internet browser
Quantum
c
3
1
5
Premium
Premium
3
a
2
b
TSX Micro
TSX Micro
b
3
3
Momentum
ATV 58
4.1
Device
T XBT F Magelis
Modem link
1
1
2
4
5
6
TSX
Micro
5
2
b
Presentation:
page 4/6
Description:
page 4/13
Characteristics:
page 4/14
References:
page 4/15
Dimensions:
page 4/15
4/8
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions (continued)
4.1
Description:
page 4/13
Characteristics:
page 4/14
References:
page 4/15
Dimensions:
page 4/15
4/9
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions (continued)
Momentum
Premium
ATV 58
4
TSX Micro
Premium
Magelis
4.1
TSX Micro
configuration,
diagnostics,
access to variables,
graphic editing,
display of predefined Web pages and
use of a Web page configuration tool.
This server is a PLC real-time data server. All TSX Micro PLC CPU data which
support one of these modules are presented in the form of standard HTML-web
pages and can also be accessed by all standard browsers capable of embedded
Java or by FactoryCast software (supplied on CD-Rom with each Ethernet module).
All functions from the Web server do not require any configuration or programming,
either on the level of the TSX Micro PLC, or on the level of the compatible PC which
supports the Internet browser. Furthermore, this module can be used in an existing
configuration without any modification to the current program.
Presentation:
page 4/6
Description:
page 4/13
Characteristics:
page 4/14
References:
page 4/15
Dimensions:
page 4/15
4/10
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions (continued)
Configuration function
The configuration function for the module is a predefined function. It allows:
b
b
b
b
b
b
Altering the user name and password for access to the secure page.
Configuration of the TCP/IP parameters.
Configuration of the Uni-Telway parameters.
Automatic re-configuration.
Configuration of the SNMP parameters.
The module reset.
4
4.1
Presentation:
page 4/6
Description:
page 4/13
Characteristics:
page 4/14
References:
page 4/15
Dimensions:
page 4/15
4/11
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions (continued)
4.1
This function is particularly useful for creating graphics and images intended for:
b Display, monitoring, diagnostics.
b Development of real time production reports.
b Maintenance assistance.
b User guides.
Description:
page 4/13
Characteristics:
page 4/14
References:
page 4/15
Dimensions:
page 4/15
4/12
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Description
1
2
3
4
The front of the TSX ETZ 410/510 modules are arranged as follows:
1 Three display LEDs indicating the module status (RUN, ERR, RX/TX).
2 A screened-on label indicating the module's MAC address (default address set in
the M bit).
3 A mini DIN connector for terminal port (TER address).
4 An RJ45 connector for Uni-Telway auxiliary port RS 485 serial link
(RS 485 address).
5 An RJ45 normalized connector for connecting to the Ethernet network
(10/100BASE-T address).
6 A 9 pin male SUB-D connector for RS 232 serial link (Modem).
7 A screw terminal block for connecting to the external power supply c 24 V.
8 A support plate enabling it to be fixed to the module.
6
7
8
Wiring system
The TSX ETZ 410/510 modules support two kinds of exclusive TCP/IP connections:
b By Ethernet network via 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX (RJ45) interface, see page 4/21
for accessories and connection cables.
b By Modem via RS 232 serial link, see page 4/66 for accessories and connection
cables.
4
4.1
The TSX ETZ 410/510 modules are connected to the TSX Micro PLCs
TSX 37 10/21/22 via:
b The terminal port (TER) or the auxiliary port (AUX).
b The PCMCIA RS 485 TSX SCP114 serial link.
Flow chart
The wiring chart opposite corresponds to one of the methods of connection.
The TSX ETZ 410/510 module is attached to the TSX Micro PLC via its terminal port
(TER or AUX).
1 TSX PCU 1031: Uni-Telway connection cable between a compatible PC and the
TER port of the TSX ETZ 410/510 module.
TSX Micro
Presentation:
page 4/6
3 490 NTW 000pp: shielded twisted pair cable connection right of the module
(rep. 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX) to Ethernet via hub (see page 4/21). Length from
2...80 m.
Modem
Ethernet
2 TSX ETZ CDN 003: connection cable (0.35 m cable, supplied with the
TSX ETZ 410/510 module) between the module (rep. RS 485) and the TER/AUX
port of the TSX Micro PLC. The TSX CX 100 cable authorizes a connection with
longer lengths (up to 10 m).
Functions:
pages 4/8 to 4/12
Characteristics:
page 4/14
References:
page 4/15
Dimensions:
page 4/15
4/13
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
Nature
Topology
Physical interface
Protocol
Transmission
Mode
Binary data rate
Medium
Configuration
Number of stations
Length
Ethernet
Manchester-type baseband
10/100 M bit/s with automatic recognition
10BASE-T, double shielded twisted pair of type
STP, impedance 100 15
100BASE-T, Ethernet cable category 5
conforms to standard EIA/TIA 568A
Point-to-point connection (via normalized RJ45
connector) enabling a star-shaped network to
be formed (the stations are linked to hubs or
switches). 64 stations max. per network
100 m max. between terminal device and hubs
RTC Link
Point-to-point protocol
TCP/IP services
in Uni-TE:
- client/server mode (32 simultaneous connections)
- 128 byte client/server requests (synchronous mode)
- 1Kbyte client/server requests (asynchronous mode)
In Modbus:
- client/server mode (32 simultaneous connections)
- 128 byte synchronous requests
4
4.1
Electrical specifications
Supply voltage
Nominal
Limits
c
c
Wave rate
24
19.230
5% max.
Accepted micro-cuts
ms
Permitted overvoltage
mA
mA
100
50200
Power consumption
Nominal
Limits
Power dissipation
Environment
Conforming to standards
The TSX ETZ 410/510 modules conform to the TSX Micro PLC requirements (see page 1/13),
which meet the following standards: ISO/IEC 8802-3, ANSI/IEEE Std 802.3 (4th edition
1993-07-08), conforming to the FCC-B rule for radiated emissions (50082-1)
(1) Transmission via Modem can also be by radio or satellite.
(2) Requires a standard browser on the PC (i.e. Internet Explorer version 4, Netscape version
4.05 or other) which is capable of executing Java code.
(3) Services available on the TSX ETY 510 module.
Presentation:
page 4/6
Description:
page 4/13
Functions:
pages 4/8 to 4/12
References:
page 4/15
Dimensions:
page 4/15
4/14
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References,
dimensions
Ethernet modules
for Micro
TSX 37 10/21/22
PLC
(1), (2)
Weight
kg
0.280
0.280
From
To
Use
Length
TSX P ACC 01
2m
5m
12 m
40 m
80 m
References
(3)
490 NTW 000 02
490 NTW 000 05
490 NTW 000 12
490 NTW 000 40
490 NTW 000 80
Weight
kg
2.5 m
10 m (4) (5)
TSX CX 100
Terminal port
(TER) connection
box
0.690
Derivation and
prolonging of bus
cable, end of line
adaptation
0.520
Uni-Telway
derivation bus
TSX SCA 50
TSX SCA 50
0.140
4
4.1
(1) Requires a TSX 37 10/20/21 PLC with a version u 2.0 operating system, supplied with a
TSX ETZ CDN 003 link cable (0.35 m in length). These modules should be supplied with
c 24 V. (See supply process page 2/61).
(2) Supplied with CD-Rom including the FactoryCast V2.2.1 software, the Ethernet
Transparent Ready Part A, the user manual for the Ethernet TSX ETZ 410/510 modules.
(3) Add the letter U to the end of the reference for CSA 22.1, NFPA 70 and UL approved cables
(flame-retardant).
(4) Free wire on the side of the TSX SCA 50 connection box.
(5) If the 0.35 m of TSX ETZ CDN 003 cable, supplied with the TSX ETZ 410/510 modules, is not
suitable, it is possible to use the TSX CX 100 cable (10 m in length). In this case, attach an
8 pin RJ45 connector (category 5) to the end of the free wire.
Dimensions, mounting
TSX ETZ 410/510 modules
16
5,4
88,9
140
143,7 (1)
132,7 (2)
34,63
39,83
5,15
116,7
30,7
58,55
150
151,5
Presentation:
page 4/6
Description:
page 4/13
Functions:
pages 4/8 to 4/12
Characteristics:
page 4/14
4/15
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Presentation
As part of its Transparent Ready family of products, Schneider Electric offers a range
of industrially hardened network hubs, switches, transceivers, bridges, and cables.
These Ethernet-standard communication components enable you to integrate
Ethernet solutions from the device level to the control network, and beyond to the
corporate intranet. Each ConneXium Industrial Ethernet product is designed with
compliance to Ethernet standards, and with third-party compatibility in mind.
b ConneXium Hubs connect devices and provide segments to shared
communication among PLCs. TF Hubs are low-cost solutions which enable
communications with devices, such as Momentum I/O, to Ethernet networks.
b ConneXium Switches segment the application in different zones, groups, or
cells/machines. The proper placement of switches can increase network
performance by relieving network congestion. TF switches implement SNMP
protocol, allowing standard network management tools to monitor and diagnose the
network, and thus are a key architectural component for real-time and deterministic
network communication.
b ConneXium Transceivers provide connections to fiber optic networks in areas of
high electromagnetic interference. The use of multiple transceivers enables long
distances between process areas.
4.1
Switch
Switch
Switch
Hub
Transceiver
Fiber optic
Hub
Transceiver
Premium
Quantum
Hub
Optical
loop
Hub
Hub
TSX Micro
Quantum
Momentum Magelis
I/O
Remote location
Momentum I/O
All Ethernet cabling system components are built to rigorous industrial standards,
and are designed to perform in harsh environments. ConneXium Switches and Hubs
support a high level of resilience. Their scalable redundant features - from single to
double ring structure - make it easy to build the kind of fault-tolerant network that fits
the specific requirements of your environment.
Characteristics:
pages 4/17 to 4/20
References:
page 4/21
4/16
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
Characteristics of hubs
Mechanical characteristics
Models
Operating temperature
C (F)
Relative humidity
0...60 (32...140)
10...95 % (non-condensing)
Dimensions (W x H x D)
mm
(in)
40 x 125 x 80
(1.58 x 4.92 x 3.15)
47 x 135 x 111
(1.85 x 5.31 x 4.37)
80 x 140 x 80
(3.15 x 5.51 x 3.15)
Weight
g (Lb)
520 (1.2)
240 (0.529)
900 (2)
Enclosure
IP 30
IP 20
IP 30
cUL 1950 ; FM 3810 ; FM 3611 Class 1, Div. 2; e ; Germanischer Lloyd ; IEC 61131 2
Electrical characteristics
Models
Technology
Ethernet 10 Mbit/s
Ethernet 10 Mbit/s
Interfaces
Connection type
Operating voltage
VDC
Terminal block
1 x 5-pin, pluggable
Redundancy
Power supply
4.1
Power supply and optical ring
mA
80 typical,
130 maximum
Maximum range
m (ft)
cascaded
4 max
4 max
in a ring
Number of hubs
Fault indicator
LED indicators
210 typical,
270 maximum
2 max
160 typical,
350 maximum
11 max
Power supply failure, permanent fault in hub, faulty link status of TP port
(volt-free contact 1 A max. under c 24 V)
P1, P2 power, DA/STAT, data collision, segmentation, and link status per port
References:
page 4/21
4/17
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics (continued)
Characteristics of switches
Mechanical characteristics
Models
Operating temperature
C (F)
Relative humidity
1095 % (non-condensing)
Dimensions W x H x D
mm
(in)
47 x 135 x 111
Weight
g (Lb)
230
850
43 x 143,8 x 75,2
(mounting on panel or
DIN rail )
190
Enclosure
IP 20
Models
Technology
Interfaces
- 8 10BASE-T/
100BASE-TX ports
with shielded RJ45
connectors
- 5 10BASE-T/
100BASE-TX ports
with shielded RJ45
connectors
2 100BASE-FX ports
with SC connectors
- 5 10BASE-T/
100BASE-TX ports
with shielded RJ45
connectors
Connection type
Electrical characteristics
- 5 10BASE-T/
100BASE-TX ports
with shielded RJ45
connectors
- 2 100BASE-TX
ports with RJ45
connectors
4.1
Operating voltage
VDC
Terminal block
mA
Redundancy
Maximum range
Fault indicator
LED indicators
1 x 5 contacts
Number of hubs
m (ft)
125 typical
290 max
800 max
- Power supply
- Power supply
- Optical and/or copper ring structure
- Fast media redundancy < 0.3 s
- Redundant manager
100
cascaded
in a ring
References:
page 4/21
4/18
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics (continued)
Characteristics of transceivers
Mechanical characteristics
Models
Operating temperature
Relative humidity
Dimensions (W x H x D)
0...60 (32...140)
10...95 % (non-condensing)
mm
(in)
40 x 134 x 80
(1.58 x 5.28 x 3.15)
47 x 135 x 111
(1.9 x 5.3 x 4.4)
Enclosure
IP 30
IP 20
cUL 1950 ; FM 3810 Class 1, Div. 2 ; e ; cUL 1950 ; cUL 508 ; cUL 1604 ;
Germanischer Lloyd ; IEC 61131 2
FM 3810 Class 1, Div. 2 ; e ;
Germanischer Lloyd ; IEC 61131 2
Electrical characteristics
Models
Technology
Ethernet 10 Mbit/s
Interfaces
Connection type
Operating voltage
VDC
Terminal block
Power consumption at 24 VDC
mA
80 typical
100 maximum
Power supply
Maximum range
m (ft)
Link budget
dB
Redundancy
LED indicators
160 typical
190 maximum
4.1
References:
page 4/21
4/19
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics (continued)
Characteristiques of bridges
Mechanical characteristics
Type of bridges
Operating temperature
Relative humidity
050
060
1095 % (non-condensing)
2090% (non-condensing)
Dimensions (W x H x D)
mm
35 x 95 x 60
Weight
4263
500
Enclosure
IP 20
UL, CSA, e
Electrical characteristics
Type of modules
Networks link
Modbus to Ethernet
Technology
Ethernet 10 Mbit/s
Interfaces
Connection type
24 DC
Power consumption
1 A typical
125 mA max
Redundancy
Power supply
10BASE-T: 100
10BASE2: 100
10BASE5: 100
Modbus Plus: 450
10BASE-T: 100
4
4.1
Operating power
References:
page 4/21
4/20
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
References
Industrial ConneXium
Description
Hubs
Tranceivers
Available ports
Reference
10 Mbit/s
Weight
kg
1,450
4 10BASE-T ports
0,520
3 10BASE-T ports
2 10BASEFL ports
0,900
100 Mbit/s
4 100BASE-TX ports
0,520
10/100 Mbit/s
0,190
1,450
1,450
100 Mbit/s
Type of connection
Available ports
Reference
Modbus Plus/Ethernet
(dual/simple pair Modbus)
Modbus/Ethernet
1 10BASE-T/10BASE-TX port
(type RJ45)
Utilisation
Reference
10 Mbit/s
0,520
Description
Bridges
499 NES 171 00
0,520
Weight
kg
4,260
0,500
4
4.1
Accessoires de raccordement
Description
Mini transceiver
499 NTR 100 10
Weight
kg
Cbles de raccordement
Description
Shielded and foil twisted
pair cord cable
Length
5m
15 m
40 m
80 m
5m
Reference
490 NTW 000 02
(1)
490 NTW 000 05
(1)
490 NTW 000 12
(1)
490 NTW 000 40
(1)
490 NTW 000 80
(1)
490 NTC 000 05
(1)
490 NTC 000 15
(1)
490 NTC 000 40
(1)
490 NTC 000 80
(1)
490 NOC 000 05
Weight
kg
5m
Characteristics:
pages 4/17 to 4/20
4/21
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Presentation
Originally used in the automotive industry, CAN is increasingly used in general
industry. Several fieldbuses based on CAN lower layers and components are
available. The CANopen machine bus conforms to the ISO 11898 international
standard, promoted by the CAN In Automation association, which consists of users
and manufacturers and offers an excellent assurance of open access and
interoperability due to its standardised devices and communication profiles.
Lexium
MHD
TSX Micro
Advantys STB
Premium
CANopen bus
From 1 to
127 slaves
ATV 38
ATV 58/58F
FTB 1CN
TeSys
model U
FTB 1CN
Tego Power
The CANopen bus is a multimaster bus which ensures reliable deterministic access
to realtime data in control system devices. The CSMA/CA protocol is based on
broadcast exchanges, sent cyclically or on an event, which ensures optimum use of
the passband. A message handling channel can also be used to define slave
parameters.
4.2
The bus uses a double shielded twisted pair, on which 127 devices maximum are
connected by daisy chaining. The variable data rate between 20 Kbps and 1 Mbps
depends on the length of the bus (between 30 and 5000 m).
Each end of the bus must be fitted with a line terminator.
The CANopen bus is a set of profiles on CAN systems, possessing the following
characteristics:
b Open bus system.
b Data exchanges in real-time without overloading the protocol.
b Modular design allowing modification of size.
b Interconnection and interchangeability of devices.
b Standardised configuration of networks.
b Access to all device parameters.
b Synchronisation and circulation of data from cyclic and/or event-controlled
processes (short system response time).
b Interoperability between numerous international manufacturers.
Description:
page 4/23
Characteristics:
page 4/24
References:
page 4/25
4/22
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connectable devices,
description
Connectable devices
TeSys model U
Advantys FTB
The TSX CPP 110 module performs the role of the master on the CANopen bus, and
other Telemecanique devices (slaves) which can be connected on the bus are:
b TeSys model U starter-controllers.
b TeSys model d using the Tego Power installation assistance system.
b Advantys STB distributed I/O.
b Advantys FTB, IP 67 monobloc I/O splitter boxes.
b Advantys FTM, IP 67 modular I/O splitter boxes.
b Altivar 31, variable speed drives for asynchronous motors 0.1815 kW.
b Altivar 58, variable speed drives for asynchronous motors 0.3775 kW.
b Altivar 58F, variable speed drives with flux vector control for asynchronous motors
0.7555 kW.
b Twin Line TLC servodrives for brushless motors 316 A.
b Lexium MHDA servodrives for brushless motors 1.570 A.
Are also compatible:
b Any third-party device which conforms to the CANopen standard profile.
b Any CAN device which uses CAN V2.0B identifiers on the ISO 11898 physical
layer.
The TSX CPP 110 PCMCIA card supports the V4.02 CANopen standard with in
particular the heartbeat network management.
Altivar ATV 31
Description
1
2
The Modicon TSX Micro/Premium platforms connect to the CANopen bus by means
of the TSX CPP 110 type III PCMCIA card inserted in the processor or coprocessor
communication port slot.
4.2
Presentation:
page 4/22
Characteristics:
page 4/24
References:
page 4/25
4/23
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
Software setup
The CANopen bus is configured using dedicated SyCon (1) software, which should
be ordered separately, reference SYS SPU LFp CD28M.
This software is used:
b To describe all devices connected on the bus.
b To generate the .CO file including the informations relating to the devices
connected. This extension file is imported into the PLC application via the
PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro programming software.
If the configuration file is too large in relation to the TSX Micro/Premium processor
capacity (see characteristics table), it is possible to load the master configuration
directly by inserting the TSX CPP 110 card in a PCMCIA port (type III) on the PC on
which SyCon software has been installed.
In PL7, it is possible to configure the CANopen bus card so that the PLC
processor/TSX CPP 110 card exchanges are executed at the same rate as the
master task or the fast task.
The process data exchanged with the slaves can be accessed by %MW standard
words, the number of which depends on the type of processor and the task in which
the module has been declared. PL7 standard function blocks are used to define the
device parameters.
Nota : In addition to supporting the CANopen protocol which uses V2.0A standard CAN
identifiers on 11 bits, the card enables direct access to the CAN link layer via CAN V2.0B
identifiers on 29 bits, used by the majority of CAN devices. In certain applications this enables
simultaneous control of CANopen devices and dedicated CAN products.
(1) The SyCon field bus configurator software also makes it possible to describre the I/O
configuration of Profibus DP bus for Modicon Premium and Modicon Quantum platforms and
the I/O configuration of INTERBUS bus for Modicon Quantum platform.
4.2
Characteristics
Type of bus
Structure
Type
Physical interface
Topology
Access method
CANopen
Industrial bus
ISO 11898
Devices linked by daisy-chaining
CSMA/CA, multimaster, producer/consumer, prioity information
Transmission
Data rate
Medium
Physical
configuration
Number of devices
Length of bus according to data rate
127 max.
1 Mbit/s
800 Kbit/s
20
45
5 maxi (4 repeaters)
64 devices
m
Segments
Number
No. of devices per
segment
Max. length of
m
segment
Equivalent length m
of a repeater
Software configuration
170
Ko
words
words
250 Kbit/s
250
125 Kbit/s
500
32 devices
16 devices
190
210
50 Kbit/s
1000
20 Kbit/s
2500
15
Micro TSX 37
21 001/101
22 001/101
500 Kbit/s
100
08
256 %MW
32 %MW
(1) This size can be exceeded if the configuration is loaded in the memory of CANopen PCMCIA
card via the SyCon software.
Presentation:
page 4/22
Description:
page 4/23
References:
page 4/25
4/24
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
References
CANopen machine bus set
Description
Services
No. of module
per PLC/PC
1 on Micro
CANopen
- PDO cyclic
TSX 37 21/22
master V4.02 exchanges
1 on Premium
PCMCIA card - CMS
TSX P57 (1)
(type III)
message
handling (SDO) 1 on Atrium
- management TPCX
of bus operating
modes
Use
Reference
Supplied with
a tap junction
and cable
length 0.5 m
Weight
kg
0.230
The SyCon tool includes also the device description for Telemecanique I/O modules.
Description
Type
Reference
Single (1station)
Group (3 stations)
Team (10 stations)
Site (up to 10 stations)
Weight
kg
Single (1station)
Group (3 stations)
Team (10 stations)
Site (up to 10 stations)
4.2
SYS SPU LUG CD28M
SYS SPU LUT CD28M
SYS SPU LUF CD28M
Presentation:
page 4/22
Description:
page 4/23
Characteristics:
page 4/24
4/25
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description,
diagnostics
Presentation
The TSX SAZ 10 AS-Interface bus module enables the TSX Micro PLC to act as the
AS-Interface bus master. In this way up to 31 sensor/actuator type devices may be
managed on the one AS-Interface bus. Up to 4 inputs and/or outputs can be
connected to each device, giving a maximum of 248 I/O on one segment.
Sensors
XVA
indicator
bank
TSX Micro
+ TSX SAZ 10
AS-Interface bus
XAL
control
station
Intelligent
sensors
XBL
keypad
Motor starter
The AS-Interface bus comprises a master station (TSX Micro PLC) and slave
stations. The TSX SAZ 10 module supports the AS-Interface M2 profile, interrogates
the device connected on the AS-Interface bus in turn and stores the data (state of
sensors/actuators, operational status of devices) in the PLC memory.
Communication management on the AS-Interface bus is completely transparent with
regard to the PLC application program.
An AS-Interface power supply for bus must be used for powering the various
components on the AS-Interface bus. Ideally this PSU should be situated nearest to
the stations with the largest current demands.
See page 2/51, Phaseo power supplies.
4.2
Description
The TSX SAZ 10 AS-Interface bus master is a half-format module designed to slot
into the basic configurations of TSX 37 10/21/22 TSX Micro PLCs, in position 4 (one
TSX SAZ 10 module per configuration) (1).
The front panel comprises:
1 An opening with locating device for routing AS-Interface bus ribbon or round cable
(to be connected to a terminal block inside the module).
2 Four indicator lamps:
v RUN: the module is active,
v ERR: module fault or bus connection fault,
v COM: AS-Interface bus communication is active,
v AS-Interface: bus configuration error.
3 A pushbutton to transfer the AS-Interface bus display to the PLC front panel.
Diagnostics
BASE
EXT
64 16
0
R I/O
64 16
8 12
9 13
9 13
14
6 10 14
7 11 15
15
7 11 15
12
12
8 12
13
13
9 13
6 10 14
14
6 10 14
7 11 15
8 12
14
RUN
DIAG
64 16
12
13
3
WRD
The TSX Micro PLC centralised display block enables the display of the status of all
the I/O channels, and the diagnostics for devices on the AS-Interface bus (present,
missing, faulty, not conforming to the configuration):
TER
> 1s.
DIAG
3
I/O
ERR
BAT
1 Device number.
2 Control pushbutton for accessing the various operating modes of the display
block.
3 State of the 4 device inputs.
4 State of the 4 device outputs.
(1) When the TSX SAZ 10 module is in position 4, the upper position 3 can only receive a
TSX ApZ pppp analogue or TSX CTZ ppp counter half-format module.
4/26
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References,
connections
References
AS-Interface bus module
Description
AS-Interface bus
master module for
TSX 37 10/21/22
PLCs
TSX SAZ 10
Protocol
Number of I/O
Reference
AS-Interface V1
31 devices, thus
248 I/O maximum
TSX SAZ 10
Connection accessories
Description
Connection to
cable
Connection modules Via vampire clip
for ribbon cable
XZ SDE11p3
XZ SDP
Supply
Weight
kg
0.070
2 ribbon cables:
- 1 for AS-Interface
bus (yellow)
- 1 for separate
supply (black)
XZ SDE1133
0.070
XZ SDP
0.030
Length
Reference
XZ CB10201
Weight
kg
1.400
XZ CB10501
3.500
100 m
XZ CB11001
7.000
Other AS-Interface
accessories
XZ CB1pp0p
Weight
kg
0.180
4.2
Connections
TSX SAZ 10 module
XZ SDE11p3
Yellow
cable
Yellow
or
black
cable
4/27
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Software setup
Software setup
The AS-Interface bus is configured using PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro software. The
services offered are based on the principle of simplicity:
b Management of profile tables, parameters and data by the master (this
management is transparent to the user).
b Topological I/O addressing: each AS-Interface slave declared on the bus is
assigned a topological address on the bus. This is transparent to the user.
b Each sensor/actuator for the AS-Interface bus interfaces is treated as an in-rack
I/O by the TSX Micro/Premium PLC.
4
Declaration of the TSX SAZ 10 TSX Micro module
4.2
Programming
After configuration, the I/Os connected on the AS-Interface bus are processed by the
application program in the same way as an in-rack I/O of the PLC, using either the
address (e.g. %I\4.0\16.2, input 2 of slave 16 of the AS-Interface bus), or the
associated symbol (e.g. Start_conveyor).
PL7 Junior/Pro software has an integrated function block library containing the
specific diagnostic DFBs for AS-Interface bus. Its check for the appearance of any
error on the AS-Interface (bus or slaves).
4/28
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Diagnostics,
characteristics
Diagnostics
1
2
Diagnostics performed using the centralized display unit of the TSX Micro platform
or using the display unit of TSX SAY 100/1000 modules can be completed using a
PC terminal on which PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro software has been installed.
The terminal connected to the TSX Micro/Premium PLC is used to perform
diagnostics of the operating state of the AS-Interface V1 TSX SAZ 10 and
TSX SAY 100 master modules, the bus and the slave devices on the bus.
For the AS-Interface V2 TSX SAY 1000 master module, the diagnostics are identical
to those of the AS-Interface V1 module, and in addition, take into account
developments in the M2E standard.
Diagnostics are performed using a single screen divided into four sections providing
information on:
1
2
3
4
Status of the TSX SAZ 10 or TSX SAY 100/1000 module (RUN, ERR, I/O).
Status of the AS-Interface channel connected to the module.
Faulty interface (or slave).
Data relating to any selected interface (profile, parameters, forcing, etc).
4.2
Characteristics
Type of module
AS-Interface profile
Type of addressing
Product certification
Ambient air temperature
Operation
Storage
Degree of protection
Vibration resistance
Shock resistance
Number of connectable interfaces With standard addressing
(or slaves)
With extended addressing
Type of connectable interfaces
With standard addressing
TSX SAZ 10
TSX SAY 100
M2(AS-Interface V1)
Standard
AS-Interface No. 12001,
AS-Interface No. 18801,
IEC 61131 2
IEC 61131 2
0+60 C.
-25+70 C.
IP 20
Conforming to IEC 68 2 6. Fc tests.
Conforming to IEC 68 2 27. EA tests.
31 slaves
31 slaves
Discrete I/Os (4I/4O) (1)
Analog I/Os (a maximum of
4 channels)
Safety interfaces
Discrete I/Os (4I/3O)
By 3-way SUB-D connector (included with the module)
4/29
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
b ASI ABLB300p
Operating on a 100 to 240 V a.c. supply, this power
supply delivers a voltage of 30 V d.c. Available in 2.4
and 4.8 A ratings, the parallel output terminal blocks
allow the bus to be connected separately to the slaves
and the master. Input and output LEDs allow fast and
continuous diagnostics.
100-240V
24 V
AS-i : 2,4 A
ASI ABLB3002
AS-i + AS-i
GND
(1)
AS-InterfaceAS-Interface
master
module
Earth
fault
Reset
PE
100-240V
Fault
Fault +
24 V
4.2
Reset Fault
ON
OFF
AS-i : 2,4 A
ASI ABLD3002
TEST
RESET
AS-i + AS-i
GND
(2)
AS-InterfaceAS-Interface
master
module
PE
b ASI ABLM3024
Operating on a 100 to 240 V a.c. supply, this product
delivers two d.c. outputs which are totally independent in
the way they operate.
Two output voltages - 30 V d.c./2.4 A (AS-Interface
supply) and 24 V d.c./3 A - are available, so making it
possible to supply the control equipment without an
additional power supply. Input and output LEDs allow fast
and continuous diagnostics.
100-240V
24 V
b ASI ABLD300p
Operating on a 100 to 240 V a.c. supply, this power
supply delivers a voltage of 30 V d.c. Available in 2.4
and 4.8 A ratings, it allows diagnosis and management
of earth faults on AS-Interface networks. In the event
of an earth fault, the Phaseo power supply trips out,
thus stopping dialogue on the bus. Restarting is only
possible after deliberate acknowledgement of the
fault. Two I/O are provided, which may be used to
monitor status. The parallel output terminal blocks are
used to connect the bus separately to the slaves and
the AS-Interface master. Input, output and fault LEDs
allow fast and continuous diagnostics.
AS-i
AS-i : 4,8 A
ASI ABLM3024
24 V - 3 A
24 30,5 V
AS-i + AS-i
GND
(1)
AS-Interface
AS-Interface
24 V d.c. master
control
module
Characteristics:
page 4/31
References:
page 4/33
Dimensions:
page 4/33
Schneider Electric
4/30
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
ASI ABLD3004
ASI ABLM3024
24 V c
supply
Safety
EMC
Low frequency harmonic
currents
Input circuit
LED indication
Input voltage
Rated values
Permissible values
Permissible frequencies
Efficiency at nominal load
Current consumption
Current at switch-on
Power factor
V
V
Hz
%
A
Orange LED
a 100240
a 85264
4763
> 83
0.5
< 30
> 0.65
> 80
1
0.5
2.4
4.8
Output circuit
LED indication
Nominal output voltage
Nominal output current
Precision
Micro-breaks
Protection
V
A
V
Green LED
c 30 (AS-Interface)
2.4
4.8
mV
ms
3%
300 - 50
10
Permanent/automatic restart after elimination of the fault
1.1 In
Tripping if U > 1.2 Un
Undervoltage
2.4
c 24
3
100 to
120 %
U > 1.5
Un
U < 0.8
Un
4.2
Operating characteristics
Connections
Environment
Operating position
MTBF
Dielectric strength
Presentation:
page 4/30
Input
Output
Storage temperature
Operating temperature
Maximum relative humidity
Degree of protection
Vibration
mm2
mm2
C
C
h
Input/output
Input/earth
Output/earth (and input/output)
Conducted/radiated
Electrostatic discharge
Electromagnetic
Conducted interference
Mains interference
References:
page 4/33
Dimensions:
page 4/33
Schneider Electric
4/31
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics,
selection
140
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
0
10
20
30
Maximum operating temperature (C)
40
50
60
70
Selection
Upstream protection of power supplies for use on the AS-Interface system
Mains supply
a 115 V single-phase
Type of
Thermal-magnetic
protection
circuit-breaker
Single-pole
GB2 CBpp
2-pole
GB2 DBpp C60N
ASI ABLB3002
GB2 pB07 MG24517 (1)
ASI ABLB3004
GB2 pB08 MG24518 (1)
ASI ABLD3002
GB2 pB07 MG24517 (1)
ASI ABLD3004
GB2 pB08 MG24518 (1)
ASI ABLM3024 GB2 pB07 MG24517 (1)
(1) UL certified circuit-breaker.
4.2
Gg
fuse
a 230 V single-phase
Thermal-magnetic
circuit-breaker
Gg
fuse
2A
4A
2A
4A
2A
GB2 DBpp
GB2 DB06
GB2 DB07
GB2 DB06
GB2 DB07
GB2 DB06
2A
2A
2A
2A
2A
C60N
MG24516 (1)
MG17453 (1)
MG24516 (1)
MG17453 (1)
MG17453 (1)
Function diagram
10
N
5
1
ON/OFF DDT
Supply
AS-i + AS-i , and GND (4)
AS-i +
6
7
8
9
24 V
AS-i
(1)
AS-i : 2,4 A
4
3
3
or
10
Reset
(1)
Reset
(1)
Test
(3)
AS-i + AS-i
6
7
8
9
GND
(2)
(3)
(2)
(3)
(2)
(3)
(2)
Fault
AS-i
Fault +
Fault
Relay off
Relay on
Input at state 0 or contact open
Input at state 1 or contact closed
LED off
LED on
(1) 30 ms min.
(2) 15 ms.
(3) 20 ms.
(4) Warning: the earth fault detector will only operate if the earth (GND) terminal is connected.
Presentation:
page 4/30
Characteristics:
page 4/31
References:
page 4/33
Dimensions:
page 4/33
Schneider Electric
4/32
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References,
dimensions,
schemes
Output
voltage
cV
Nominal
power
W
Nominal
current
A
Auto-protect
reset
30
72
2.4
auto
no
ASI ABLB3002
0.800
145
4.8
auto
no
ASI ABLB3004
1.300
72
2.4
auto
yes
ASI ABLD3002
0.800
145
4.8
auto
yes
ASI ABLD3004
1.300
2 x 72
2.4 + 3
auto
no
ASI ABLM3024
1.300
30 + 24
Reference
Weight
kg
Dimensions
ASI ABLB3002
ASI ABLD3002
ASI ABLM3024
ASI ABLp3004
4
120
120
4.2
54
120
81
Schemes
ASI ABLM3024
ASI ABLD300p
ASI ABLB300p
Set
Fault
detector
AS-i
GND
AS-i +
GND
AS-i
AS-i +
GND
Filter
AS-i
AS-i +
ON/
OFF
GND
AS-i
AS-i +
AS-i
GND
AS-i +
Filter
GND
AS-i
AS-i +
Filter
24 V
Presentation:
page 4/30
Characteristics:
page 4/31
Schneider Electric
4/33
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Presentation
Premium
3
Ethernet TCP/IP or Fipway
Quantum
Momentum
Premium
Lexium
MHDA
XBT-F
Momentum
5
Modbus Plus
Bridge
Premium
Third-party device
TSX Micro
Modbus Plus
ATV 58
Gateway
2
Modbus
1
Quantum
4
Modbus device
The Modbus Plus network is a high-performance industrial local network which can
respond to Client/Server type extended architectures,combining a high data rate
(1 Mbit/s), simple and economical transmission support and several message
handling services.
The main data exchange functions between all devices connected to the network
are:
4.3
4/34
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Description,
characteristics
Description
The type III TSX MBP 100 card is used to connect the Premium/TSX Micro PLCs and
Atrium coprocessor to the Modbus Plus network. This card is installed in the slot
reserved for processors or coprocessors:
1 A host slot on processors or coprocessors.
2 A protective cover.
1
4
Characteristics
Structure
Transmission
Type
Industrial bus
Physical interface
RS 485
Method of access
Token bus
Mode
Synchronous HDLC
Data rate
1 Mbit/s
Medium
Twisted pair
Number of devices
Number of addresses
Length of bus
Number of segments
Global database
Peer Cop
Cyclical exchange service (on Premium only): 500 words per station (broadcast or
point-to-point)
4.3
Configuration
Services
4/35
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connections
Wiring system
11
9
7
7
12
10
1
4.3
1 TSX MBP 100: Modbus Plus PCMCIA card, for type III processor slot on TSX Micro
or Premium platforms.
2 170 PNT 110 20: communication module for Momentum I/O base unit.
3 490 NAA 271 0p: trunk cable, shielded twisted pair with shielding drain (flying
leads). In lengths of 30, 150, 300, 450 or 1,500 m.
4 170 MCI 020/021 p p: drop cable equipped at each end with an RJ45 connector
(baseT interface). In lengths of 0.25, 0.75, 3 or 10 m.
5 990 NAD 230 00: IP 20 local site tap, provides a tap link from the trunk cable for
connecting 1 device (connection of conductors requires wiring tool 043 509 383).
Integrates the line terminal.
6 990 NAD 230 10: IP 65 zamac local site tap, provides a tap link from the trunk
cable for connecting 1 device (screw terminal connection). It also has an RJ45
connector for connecting a programming and maintenance terminal.
7 170 XTS 020 00: IP 20 tee, provides a tap link from the Modbus Plus cable (cable
with connectors at each end of an RJ45 connector). It has a 9-way SUB-D female
connector for connecting the device.
8 TSX MBP CE 030/060: drop cable for Modbus Plus PCMCIA card, equipped on
the PCMCIA side with a 20-way miniature connector and with flying leads on the
990 NAD 230 00/010 local site tap side. In lengths of 3 or 6 m.
9 990 NAD 211 10/30: drop cable equipped on the device side with a 9-way SUB-D
male connector and with flying leads on the 990 NAD 230 00/010 local site tap
side. In lengths of 2, 4 or 6 m.
10 TSX MBP CE 002: drop cable for Modbus Plus PCMCIA card, equipped on the
PCMCIA side with a 20-way miniature connector and on the network side with a
9-way SUB-D female connector. Can be used as an extension for cable
990 NAD 211 10/30. In lengths of 0.2 m.
11 AS MBKT 185: set of 2 line terminators (impedance adapter) to be placed at
each end of the segment. The AS MBKT 185 terminators are placed directly at the
end of the cable (without a tap or tee).
990 NAD 230 11: set of 2 line terminators (impedance adapter) for IP 65 local site
tap 990 NAD 230 10, to be placed at each end of the segment.
12 170 XTS 021 00: set of 2 line terminators (impedance adapter) for tee
170 XTS 020 00, to be placed at each end of the segment.
For wiring system:
b Quantum platform: please refer to our catalog.
b Lexium drive for brushless motors: please refer to our catalog Lexium movement
command.
b Altivar drive for asynchronous motors: please refer to our catalog Progressive
starters and speed controllers.
4/36
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Reference
Description Number per PLC Use
Weight
kg
0.110
Reference
(1)
170 PNT 110 20
Weight
kg
0.110
Addr.
Reference
Weight
kg
0.230
6
6
0.650
0.260
11
AS MBKT 185
11
11
12
Sold in lot of 4
Addr. Length
Reference
10
30 m
150 m
300 m
450 m
1,500 m
0.25 m
1m
3m
10 m
0.2 m
3m
0.340
6m
0.530
1 PCMCIA
type III card
Addr.
Mounting
taps
043 509 283
IP 20 tap for tap link connection (screw DIN rail
terminal connection), supports 1 RJ45 Mounting plate
connector on front panel
IP 65 tap for tap link connection (tee),
supports 1 RJ45 connector on front
panel
IP 20 tee with 2 RJ45 connectors for
Modbus Plus cable and 1 9-way SUB-D
connector for tap link devices
Line
2 impedance adapters for local site tap
terminators (IP 20) 990 NAD 230 00
(set of 2)
2 impedance adapters for tap (IP 20)
990 NAD 230 20/21
2 impedance adapters for local site tap
(IP 65) 990 NAD 230 10
Mounting kit
for IP 65 tee
Protector
pack
Wiring tool
4.3
To
Local site tap 990 NAD 230 00/10
Drop cables IP 20
IP 20 170 XTS 020 00 tee
170 XTS 020 00
tee
PCMCIA card
TSX MBP 100
(miniature
connector)
Weight
kg
0.530
0.530
4/37
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description
Modbus Bus
Presentation
Magelis iPC
ATV 58
Modbus
XBT
TSX Micro/Premium
April 5000
Quantum
The Modbus bus is used for master/slave architectures (it is necessary, however,
to check that the Modbus services used by the application are implemented on the
devices concerned).
The bus comprises one master station and several slave stations. Only the master
station can initiate the exchange (direct communication between slave stations is not
possible). Two exchange mechanisms are possible:
b Question/answer, where the requests from the master are addressed to a given
slave. The master then waits for the response from the slave which has been
interrogated.
b Broadcasting, the master broadcasts a message to all the slave stations on the
bus. These stations execute the order without transmitting a response.
Description
4.3
The TSX Micro/Premium PLCs or Atrium coprocessors offer various Modbus bus
connection possibilities.
1
Built-in links to the TSX Micro processor or to the TSX SCY p1601 Premium
module
1 Via integrated port on the TSX Micro processor.
The TER port (8-way mini DIN) has Modbus RTU master/slave (1) protocol.
TSX Micro
2 Via integrated port on the TSX SCY 11601/21601 module for Premium PLCs.
This module has an isolated Half-duplex RS 485 serial link channel (25-way SUB-D
connector) with multiprotocol (including Modbus); (for the TSX SCY 11601
module, only the Modbus protocol is supported).
3
6
5
4
Premium
3 A slot on the TSX Micro/Premium processors, the Atrium coprocessor and the
TSX SCY 21601 module(2) exists for the multiprotocol TSX SCP11p cards,
including Modbus, featuring:
4 A protective cover.
5 A removable cover with fixing screws (to access a 20-way miniature connector).
6 Two LEDs:
v ERR lamp: card or link fault,
v COM lamp: data transmission or reception.
References:
pages 4/40 and 4/41
4/38
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
Modbus Bus
Characteristics
Physical Interface
Structure
Transmission
Configuration
PCMCIA card
Isolated
RS 485 (1)
Type
Non-isolated RS 485
TSX 37 05/08 TSX
37 10/21/22
Heterogeneous industrial bus
Method of access
Slave
Master/slave Type
Mode
Asynchronous in baseband
Frame
RTU
RTU/ASCII
Data rate
1.2...14.2 Kbps
Medium
Number of devices
28 max. in RS 485
Point-to-point in RS 422
98
98
Tap links
Services
Master/slave
248
1,300 m
excluding tap
links
15 m max.
Requests
Security
Monitoring
No flow control
Code
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
0B
0C
0F
10
11
20 mA CL
Non-isolated
RS 232D
248
100 to 1,000 m 15 m max.
according to
rate
98
1,300 m excluding C
15 m
Modbus master
Read bits
Read input bits (3)
Read words
Read input words (3)
Write 1 bit or n bits
Write 1 word or n words
Exceptional read status
Diagnostic
Event counter
Event connection
Slave identification
Other requests accessible via SEND_REQ
generic function blocks
4.3
References:
pages 4/40 and 4/41
4/39
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Modbus Bus
Protocol
Physical layer
Reference
Weight
kg
Modbus (RTU)
Uni-Telway
character mode
Non-isolated RS 485
Communication
module for
Premium/Atrium
Modbus
Character mode
Uni-Telway
0.360
Modbus
0.340
0.105
RS 232D (9 signals)
0.6...19.2. Kbps
0.105
20 mA CL
1.2...19.2. Kbps
0.105
TSX Micro
PCMCIA cards
type III for Premium
processor, Atrium
coprocessor, PLC
TSX 37 21/22 or
TSX SCY 21601
module
Modbus
Character mode
Uni-Telway
4.3
TSX SCA 50
Use
Reference
Weight
kg
0.520
Passive junction
box
TSX SCA 50
2 channel passive
subscriber socket
(2 or 4 wire) (2)
0.570
Active adapter
RS 232C/RS 485
TSX SCA 72
0.520
TSX P ACC 01
0.690
Line terminators
(sold in lot of 2)
TSX SCA 10
0.030
TSX SCA 64
2/4-wire cabling
Can be connected to the front panel of the TSX SCA 64
subscriber socket
(1) PCMCIA type III slot for 1 TSX SCP 111/112/114, TSX FPP 20 or TSX JNP 112/114 card.
(2) 2 or 4 wire cabling, compatible with the TSX SCA 64 subscriber socket requires a max. 10 mm
external diameter Modbus cable.
Characteristics:
page 4/39
4/40
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References (suite)
Modbus Bus
Use
From
Modbus Bus
Built-in channel
(channel 0) Premium
TSX SCY 11601,
TSX SCY 21601
module
Length
Reference
100 m
5.680
200 m
10.920
500 m
30.000
3m
0.160
0,180
Modbus standard
device, 4 wires (1)
(point-to-point)
3m
0.160
3m
0.160
0.160
Communication device 3 m
(Modem, converter, etc)
(DCE) (2)
0.190
Terminal device
with point-to-point
(DTE) (2)
3m
0.190
10 m
0.620
0.160
To
Weight
kg
4.3
3m
Other connecting
cables
Characteristics:
page 4/39
4/41
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Communication
architecture
Level 3
Ethernet
Monitor Pro
Ethernet TCP/IP (Uni-TE, Modbus)
Ethernet TCP/IP
(Uni-TE, Modbus)
Level 2
TSX Micro
TSX ETZ
TSX ETZ
Modbus bus
Uni-Telway bus
Premium
Modem
ATV 28
ATV 58
Level 1
Modem
TSX Micro
Fipway/Modbus Plus
TSX Micro
4.4
TSX Micro
Magelis
AS-Interface bus
Nano
Nano
4/42
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Digital HP
Magelis iPC (1)
Quantum
Ethernet
Premium
Magelis iPC
Modbus Plus
I/O Scanning
Momentum
TSX Micro
Premium
Bridge
Premium
4.4
ATV 58
T XBT F Magelis
AS-interface bus
Quantum
Sensors
AS-interface bus
Motor starter
T
Bus X
XAL control
station
Intelligent
sensors
XBL keypad
Motor starter
(1) PC industriel Magelis iPC in configuration Thin Client : PC having only Windows and an
Internet browser.
4/43
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
X-way communication
Telegram
7
Application
Uni-TE
Modbus (1)
Uni-TE
Presentation
Session
Transport
Network
Link
Uni-Telway
WorldFip
ISO 8802 3
Ethernet
ISO 8802 3
Ethernet
Physical
RS 485
19.2 Kbps
WorldFip
1 Mbps
ISO 8802 3
10 Mbps
10/100 Mbps
Uni-Telway
Fipio/Fipway
Ethway
TCP
X-Way addressing system
IP
ISO 8802 3
Ethernet TCP
The physical layer enables the physical transmission of data signals between
2 systems via a medium. In order for a network to operate correctly, and to ensure
full security of personnel in compliance with IEC 1131 2, it is necessary to implement
the wiring recommendations described in the reference manual TSX DR NET F
X-Way communication (or in the TSX CD DMTE 13E CD-ROM Technical
documentation).
4.4
database (4)
database
Application-to256 bytes
128 bytes
128 bytes
240 bytes (3)
application
Telegram
16 bytes
Uni-TE services
The Uni-TE protocol is the industrial message handling system supported by the
X-Way communication architecture. It operates on the question/answer or
request/confirmation principle. A device which supports the Uni-TE protocol can be a:
b Client: this device initiates communication. It asks a question (reads), transmits data
(writes) or sends an instruction (Run, Stop, etc.).
b Server: this device executes the service requested by the client and sends a
confirmation after execution.
4/44
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
X-way communication
The services provided depend on the type of device (PLC, numerical controller,
programming terminal, supervision station, etc.). Depending on its function, each
device can be Client and/or Server. A Client PLC can access other devices on the
architecture via its application program: It can read/write objects on another PLC or
numerical controller, select programs on a numerical controller, etc.
Network transparency
When connected to any station in the network or directly connected to the Fipway/
Ethernet TCP/IP network, a programming terminal can communicate with any other
station in the network (as if the terminal were physically connected to the PLC with
which it is dialoguing).
Network transparency also applies between stations connected to different
segments of the same multinetwork architecture.
COM service and Shared Table service (exclusive services one from another)
The COM service is made up of a set of dedicated words called common words.
Each Fipway/Ethway network station may or may not access the database (in read
only or read/write mode).
All PLC stations exchanging common words (32 stations on Fipway, 64 stations on
Ethway) are allocated, in a dedicated database (128 words for Fipway, 256 words for
Ethway), a write zone (set at 4 words for the Fipway network, and variable from 4 to
64 words for the Ethway network) per TSX Micro/Premium station.
COM words are updated automatically during each scan of the general sequential
program (master task) without the intervention of the application program.
The Shared Table service can be used to exchange a table of internal words
divided into as many zones as there are TSX Micro/Premium PLCs which comprise
the Fipway network. The exchange principle is based on the broadcasting, by each
PLC, of a word memory zone (broadcast zone) to the other PLCs on the network.
Each network station is allocated an exchange table comprising 128 internal words
for the 32 PLCs that share the service, with a broadcast zone assigned to each PLC,
variable from 1 to 32 internal words.
Application-to-application communication
This consists of using the user application program to send word tables between
2 devices, which may be TSX Micro/Premium and TSX PLCs.
This service is particularly suitable for:
b Sending alarm messages from a PLC to a supervision station.
b Exchanging data tables between two PLCs controlled by the application programs
of the transmission and destination device.
b Sending broadcast messages to all stations and devices.
4.4
Telegram
The telegram service available on Fipway is a special case of application-toapplication messages. It enables short messages to be sent and received on a
priority basis (maximum 16 characters).
A telegram from a TSX Micro/Premium PLC is sent immediately without waiting for
the end of the cycle. The telegram is received by the TSX Micro/Premium PLC in:
b The event-triggered task (processed as soon as the message arrives in the
network card).
b The fast task or master task (when scanning the reception function).
b A PLC can only process one telegram at a time.
Use in a multinetwork
The X-Way communication architecture is designed to cover multinetwork
applications capable of dealing with problems of:
b Concentration, the architecture is particularly suitable for feedback of supervision
data to a higher level.
b Redundancy, each PLC monitors the correct operation of both networks to which
it is connected. If one of the networks should fail, all traffic could be transferred to the
valid network.
b Inter-network communication. These architectures comprise several network
segments which are interconnected by bridge PLC stations. Transparent
communication is then offered between the entire architecture.
4/45
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Fipway network
Presentation
Magelis iPC
Ethernet TCP/IP
Premium
Fipway
TSX
TSX 17 20
Premium
TSX Micro
Bus X
4
The Fipway network is an open local area network for communication between the
various TSX Micro, Premium and TSX Series 7 PLCs using the X-Way services.
Communication conforms to the FIP standard with access via a bus arbitrator.
TSX Micro (TSX 37 21/22) and Premium PLCs can be connected to a Fipway
network using a Fipway PCMCIA card which is inserted in each processor or into the
TSX SCY 21601 (Premium) communication module. Supported X-Way services
(see pages 4/44 to 4/45) are:
b Uni-TE services.
b Distributed database (COM) or Shared Table.
b Telegram (service only available when the PCMCIA card is inserted in the
processor).
b Application-to-application communication.
4.4
For characteristics, Fipway network wiring and connection accessories, see pages
4/56 to 4/59.
Characteristics:
page 4/41
References:
page 4/48
Performances:
page 4/43
4/46
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
Fipway network
Characteristics
The Fipio industrial fieldbus is standard of communication between various control
system components. It conforms to the WorldFip standard.
Type of bus/network
Structure
Type
Fipway network
Open industrial fieldbus conforming to WordFip standard
Topology
Maximum length
Transmission
Access method
Producer/consummer principal
Management by fixed arbitrator
Mode
Data rate
Mbit/s
Number of
devices
Segments
Per segment
32 stations
Maxi
64 stations
Number
Unlimited
Length
Services
150 shielded twisted pair, 62.5/125 ou 50/125 fibre optic using electrical/fibre optic repeaters
Medium
Configuration
5 000
COM (1)
Shared table(1)
Uni-TE
Point-to-point requests with confirmation report: 128 bytes maximum, can be used by all
devices connected to the same X-Way architecture (access by the Client device to the Server
device system functions)
Application-to-application
Point-to-point messages: 128 bytes maximum between 2 devices, can be used by all
TSX Micro (1)/Premium/TSX Serie 7
Telegram
Point-to-point priority messages: 16 bytes maximum between 2 Premium (3) or TSX Series 7
stations with addresses 0 to 15
Security
4.4
(1) The COM and Shared table service are mutualy exclusive.
(2) Service reserved for TSX Micro and Premium PLCs.
(3) Service only available when Fipway PCMCIA card is installed in the processor.
Presentation:
page 4/40
References:
page 4/42
Performances:
page 4/43
4/47
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Performances,
description
Fipway network
Performances
The operating principle of a Fipway network gives ensured, constant network cycle
times whatever the traffic and number of stations (2 to 64). This enables the Fipway
network to be updated (addition or removal of stations) without changing
the performance.
Event
Report
CT1 CT1
Device 1
Fipway network
Device 2
CT1 CT1
NCT NCT
CT2 CT2
Action
The response time must be evaluated by the designer of each application in relation
to the devices connected.
The processing time of a device can vary from one to two cycle times as a function
of asynchronous operation.
Connectable devices
TSX 7 PLCs
Equipped with
TSX FPC 10M for PC
compatible (ISA bus).
They access all devices in
the X-Way architecture. The
various X-Way drivers are
available on CD-ROM, see
page 5/19.
4.4
Presentation:
page 4/40
Characteristics:
page 4/41
References:
page 4/42
4/48
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Fipway network
Description
3
4
2
1
TSX Micro/Premium PLCs have a slot on the processor for a type III PCMCIA
communication card. This can be fitted with the TSX FPP 20 fipway network
connection card, which is also inserted into the TSX SCY 21601 communication
module slot.
The TSX FPP 20 card comprises:
1 Protective cover
2 Removable cover with fixing screws for access to the 20-way miniature connector
3 Two indicator lamps:
v ERR lamp: card fault, link fault,
v COM lamp: data transmission or reception.
Connector to be ordered separately:
TSX FP CG 010/030, 1 or 3 m cable for connection to the TSX FP ACC 3/ACC 4
T-junction box (on 9-way SUB-D connector).
References
Description
Fipway card
TSX FPP 20
Number per
Premium
PLC
1 with 37 20
1 with 57 10
1 with 57 20
3 with 57 30
4 with 57 40
Use
Composition
1 type lll
Type lll slot on,
PCMCIA
- TSX Micro/
Premium processor card
- TPCX 57 10/30
coprocessor
- TSX SCY 21601
module
Reference
TSX FPP 20
Weight
kg
0.110
Set of X-Way
drivers for PC
compatible
0.360
Use
From
TSX FPP 20
card
(miniature
connector)
To
TSX FP ACC 3/4
box (SUB-D 9-way
connector)
Length
Reference
1m
TSX FP CG 010
Weight
kg
0.210
3m
TSX FP CG 030
0.410
4.4
TSX FP CG 010/030
(1) For other Fipway network accessories and connection cables, see pages
4/58 and 4/59.
Presentation:
page 4/40
Characteristics:
page 4/41
Performances:
page 4/42
4/49
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Presentation
Premium
(Bus manager)
Lexium
Momentum
CCX 17
Fipio bus
ATV 58
Intelligent
sensors
XAL keyboard
Premium (Agent)
Bus AS-i
Motor starter
T
TSX Micro (TSX 37 21/22) or Premium PLCs, fitted with a TSX FPP 10 PCMCIA card
on their integrated communication channel, are agents on the Fipio bus. The bus
manager is a TSX P 57 153/253/2823/353/453/4823, Atrium coprocessor
T PCX 57 203/353.
The Fipio bus enables I/O to be remotely located close to the devices to be controlled
(Momentum, Altivar, etc). The Agent function enables offline processing, by locating
a TSX Micro PLC close to the machine.
In addition to the standard Fipio services (see pages 4/39 to 4/45), TSX Micro
(TSX 37 21/22) and Premium PLCs allow exchanges of input and output variables
with the bus manager PLC. These exchanges are performed cyclically, automatically
and without the involvement of the application program at the same rate as the task for
which the agent PLC has been configured.
4.4
For characteristics, Fipio bus wiring system and connection accessories, see
pages 4/50 to 4/59.
Application services
The application services supported by TSX Micro (TSX 37 21/22) and Premium
Agent function PLCs are:
b Uni-TE service, X-Way industrial message handling service suitable for operator
dialogue, diagnostics and control functions (requests of up to 128 bytes).
b Application-to-application communication service, which consists of the
transmission of tables between 2 devices controlled by their respective application
programs (messages of up to 128 bytes).
b New periodic data exchange service for exchanging a 64 word table between the
bus manager PLC and the Premium Agent PLC. Sofware setup see page 4/52.
Characteristics:
page 4/51
References:
page 4/52
Description:
page 4/53
4/50
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
Characteristics
The Fipio industrial fieldbus is standard of communication between various control
system components. It conforms to the WorldFip standard.
Type of bus/network
Structure
Type
Fipio bus
Open industrial fieldbus conforming to WordFip standard
Topology
Maximum length
Transmission
Access method
Producer/consummer principal
Management by fixed arbitrator
Mode
Data rate
Mbit/s
Number of
devices
Segments
Per segment
Maxi
Number
Unlimited
Length
Services
150 shielded twisted pair, 62.5/125 ou 50/125 fibre optic using electrical/fibre optic repeaters
Medium
Configuration
15 000
Input/output exchanges
Periodic and deterministic exchanges of variables between bus manager PLC and Agent PLC
(64 %MWi consecutive words: 32 %MWi for transmmission and 32 %MWi for reception)
Uni-TE
Point-to-point requests with confirmation report: 128 bytes maximum, can be used by all
devices connected to the same X-Way architecture (access by the Client device to the Server
device system functions)
Application-to-application
Point-to-point messages: 128 bytes maximum between 2 devices, can be used by all
TSX Micro(1)/Premium/TSX Serie 7
Security
4.4
Presentation:
page 4/50
References:
page 4/52
Description:
page 4/53
4/51
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Software setup,
description
Software setup
Each TSX Micro/Premium PLC Fipio Agent uses 64 %MWi consecutive internal
words to exchange periodic data. The first 32 words are reserved for sending data to
the manager, and the remaining 32 are reserved for receiving data from the manager.
PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro application-specific screens allow the configuration of the Fipio
Agent PCMCIA card. This consists of:
b Indicating the connection point number (1 to 127).
b Indicating the address at the beginning of the 64 %MW word table reserved for
sending data to and receiving data from the manager.
Description
TSX Micro (TSX 37 21/22)/Premium PLCs have a slot in the processor for a type III
PCMCIA communication card. This can be fitted with a TSX FPP 10 Fipio bus
connection card.
2 4
4.4
Presentation:
page 4/50
Characteristics:
page 4/51
Description:
page 4/53
4/52
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
References
Fipio bus connection component
Description
Composition
Use
Fipio Agent
1 type III PCMCIA
function card Version V1.8
TSX FPP 10
Reference
Weight
kg
0.110
TSX FP ACC 3
Use
Reference
TSX FP ACC 3
Weight
kg
0.090
TSX FP ACC 4
0.660
4
TSX FP ACC 4
Use
From
Cables for
TSX FPP 10
PCMCIA card card (miniature
connector)
Length
To
TSX FP ACC 4 1 m
cable connector
(9-way SUB-D
connector)
3
Reference
TSX FP CG 010
Weight
kg
0.210
TSX FP CG 030
0.410
(1) For other Fipio bus accessories and connection cables, see pages 4/52 and 4/53.
TSX FP CG 010/030
4.4
Presentation:
page 4/50
Characteristics:
page 4/51
References:
page 4/52
4/53
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Presentation
The OZD FIP G3 optic transceivers are particularly adapted for use with applications
which are subject to harsh electrical environments or which are distributed over large
areas:
b Public buildings.
b Large-scale industrial sites.
b Water treatment and distribution.
b Transport and highway tunnel infrastructures, etc.
The OZD FIP G3 optic transceiver enables conversion of a FIP electric interface to
2 FIP optic interfaces and vice versa. As a result, it allows redundant ring topologies
to exist; these improve installation availability even when a line is broken at a point
in the medium.
In these situations, the length of the bus or the Fipio/Fipway ring can reach 20 Km,
with a maximum of 32 Fipio or 20 Fipway transceivers. See characteristics on
page 4/49. These characteristics may be increased using mixed topologies such as
2 serial optic rings or 2 serial optic buses; please consult our regional office.
Wiring system
Premium
CCX 17
3
4
2
1
2
1
6
1
4.4
Optic ring
6
3
5
5
Third party
Momentum
TSX Micro or
Premium + TSX FPP 10
Magelis iPC + TSX FPC 10M
Characteristics:
page 4/55
References:
page 4/55
4/54
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation (continued),
characteristics,
references
Performances
Fipio bus operating mode and performance on fiber optics
After configuration in Fipio mode, the processor scans the various application
devices according to the software configuration:
b Image variables of the input values and of the output command values of a
configured device are scanned as quickly as possible on the bus, whilst respecting
the existing relationships between periods of different tasks which use these devices.
b Appearance or disappearance of a configured device is detected on the bus within
a maximum time of 200 ms.
b Exchanges occur at the rate defined by the programmer, from 10 to 20 Uni-TE
messages per second.
The network cycle time is double that of the electrical bus when OZD FIP G3
transceivers are used.
Fipway bus operating mode and performance on fiber optics
The operating principle is identical to that on an electrical network, in that the number
of stations is limited to 32 and the transmission time is as follows:
b For the Common words and Shared Table services, updating of the entire
database is carried out every 40 ms maximum.
For Uni-TE message handling, the network characteristics are used to transmit a
maximum of 230 messages of 128 bytes per second.
Fipio bus
Structure
Type
Topology
Access method
Transmission
Mode
Data rate
Medium (2)
Inter-repeater distance
No. of connection points
Maximum no. of devices
Configuration
No. of segments
Length
Maximum optic distance
between 2 OZD FIP G3
transceivers
Tap links
Services
Fipway network
4.4
References
Description
Optic transceiver
Fipio/Fipway (3)
Max. number of
transceivers
32 with Fipio
20 with Fipway
Connectable devices
Fipio bus
- TSX Micro/Premium
- TBX remote I/Os with
TBX LEP 30
- Remote Momentum I/O
- CCX 17 panels (version 2.4)
- Magelis iPC industrial PCs
- Lexium drives, etc.
Fipway
Reference
network
TSX Micro,
OZD FIP G3
Premium (with
TSX FPP 20
PCMCIA card)
Weight
kg
0.500
Use
Composition Reference
Fipway card
1 type III
TSX FPP OZD 200
PCMCIA card
0.110
1 type III
TSX FPP 10
PCMCIA card
0.110
Weight
kg
(1) These characteristics can be increased using mixed topologies; please consult our regional
office.
(2) Devices connected on electrical tap links are compatible with the WorldFip physical layer.
(3) For TSX FP ACC 8M fiber optic electrical repeater, see page 4/58.
(4) For accessories and connection cables, see pages 4/58 and 4/59.
Presentation:
page 4/54
4/55
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connections
5
Daisy
chaining
1 or 2
14
13
1 or 2
Daisy
chaining
24 V
15
10
7
or
1 or 2
13
12
11
TSX Series 7
model 40
Integrated link
14
24 V
14
24 V
11
TSX SAP 10
TBX (IP 20)
10
or
14
TSX SAP 10
TBX (IP 20)
CCX 17
FipConnect third-party
products
or
TSX 17 20
TSX 17 20
Daisy chaining
14
1 or 2
TSX Series 7
model 40
Integrated link
Proof I/O IP 65 or
IP 67 (1)
F
Connection to Fipway network and Fipio bus
Connection to Fipway bus
Connection to Fipio bus
(1) Dust and damp proof I/O modules on Fipio bus for IP 65 modules: TBX EEP/ESP modules and connections, see pages 4/6 to 4/11, IP 67 modules:
TSX EEF/ESF/EMF modules and connections, consult our Modicon Premium automation platform catalogue.
Connectable devices
Devices to be connected on Fipio
4.4
Premium
TSX Micro
TSX Series 7 model 40 (integrated link)
TSX Series 7 model 40 (PCMCIA)
TSX 17 20
XBT-F, TXBT-F Magelis terminals
Magelis iPC industrial PC
PC compatible
LUF P1 Modbus gateway
Boxes
TSX FP
TSX FP
TSX FP
TBX FP
ACC4 8 ACC14 6 ACC3 7 ACC10
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
C/D (2)
D (1)
TSX EF
ACC99
Connectors
TSX FP
TSX FP
TBX
TBX
ACC 2 9 ACC12 9 BLP01 10 BLP10
C/D
C/D
C/D
C/D
C/D
TBX
BAS10
C/D
C/D
C/D
C/D
C/D
D
C/D (3)
D (3)
TBX
BLP10
TBX
BAS10
C/D
D
D
Boxes
TSX FP
TSX FP
TSX FP
TBX FP
ACC4 8 ACC14 6 ACC3 7 ACC10
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
TSX EF
ACC99
C/D
Connectors
TSX FP
TSX FP
TBX
ACC2 9 ACC12 9 BLP01
C/D
C/D
C/D
C/D
C/D
recommended connection
C: connection by daisy chaining
possible connection
D: connection by tap link
(1) Possible if only one TBX IP 65 module is used.
(2) The connection by daisy chaining with the TBX FP ACC 10 connection box is only possible with the first TBX module on Fipio bus.
(3) The TBX BAS connector is only used for TBX IP 65 output modules.
Characteristics:
page 4/50
4/56
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connections (continued)
Cables
1 TSX FP CAp00: trunk cable, shielded twisted pair 150 (8 mm diameter) for
normal environments and use inside buildings.
2 TSX FP CRp00: trunk cable, shielded twisted pair 150 and 1 x 1.5 mm2 pair for
remote supply (9.5 mm diameter) for harsh environments and use outside
buildings.
3 TSX FP CCp00: tap link cable, shielded twisted pair 150 ( 8 mm diameter) for
normal environments and use inside buildings.
4 TSX FP CG0p0: tap link connecting cable for PCMCIA TSX FPP 10/20
communication card for TSX Micro/Premium/TSX Series 7 PLCs, FT 2100
terminals and PC compatibles. Connection to the bus is via a 9-way
SUB-D connector on the TSX FP ACC3/ACC4 junction box.
5 TSX FP CE030: tap link connecting cable for TSX FPC 10 or FCP FPC 10 PC
communication card (ISA bus) for FTX 517, CCX 77/87 terminals and PC
compatibles. Connection to the bus is via a 9-way SUB-D connector on the
TSX FP ACC 3/ACC 4 junction box.
Connection boxes
6 TSX FP ACC14: Polycarbonate IP 20 junction box: provides tap link from the trunk
cable to connect 1 device via TSX FP CCp00 tap link cable or several devices in
a daisy chain.
7 TSX FP ACC3: IP 20 box for connecting 2 PC or PCMCIA cards (TSX FPP 10,
TSX FPC 10, TSX FPP 20/200, FCP FPP 10) on a 9-way SUB-D connector.
8 TSX FP ACC4: IP 65 junction box. It also has a 9-way female SUB-D connector
for any device which is connected to the bus via a PCMCIA card (in this case, the
box is IP 20).
TSX EF ACC99: IP 65 junction box for IP 67 I/O modules, consult our Modicon
Premium automation platform catalogue.
Connectors
9 TSX FP ACC2 and TSX FP ACC12: 9-way female SUB-D connector for
Fipway/Fipio connection (TSX FP ACC 2 connector for TSX 17 20 micro-PLC for
example). Used for daisy chain or tap link connection (90 output high or low, 45
output high or low).
4.4
4/57
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Use
Rep.
Reference
Weight
kg
0.080
TSX FP ACC2
10
TSX FP ACC12
0.040
TSX FP ACC14
0.120
TSX FP ACC3
0.090
TSX FP ACC4
0.660
TSX EF ACC99
0.715
TSX FP ACC 12
Female isolating
Connection by daisy chaining
connector for devices with or tap link black polycarbonate material IP 20
9-way SUB-D connectors
Insulated bus connection Trunk cable tap link (for connecting the c 24 V
6
box
power supply of TBX dust and damp proof modules)
(black polycarbonate, IP 20)
TSX FP ACC14
TSX FP ACC3
TSX FP ACC4
4.4
Line terminators
(sold in lots of 2)
2 impedance adaptors
14
TSX EF ACC7
0.020
Electrical repeater
(IP 65)
TSX FP ACC6
0.520
Electrical/fibre optic
repeater
(IP 65)
TSX FP ACC8M
0.620
TSX FP ACC9
0.050
13
TSX EF ACC99
TSX FPC10M
0.140
(1) The characteristics and performances of the Fipio bus or Fipway network are dependent on the above TSX FP accessories
being used.
4/58
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References (continued),
Dimensions
Type
Trunk cables
Conditions of use
TSX FP CA100
Weight
kg
5.680
200 m
TSX FP CA200
10.920
500 m
TSX FP CA500
30.000
100 m
TSX FP CR100
7.680
200 m
TSX FP CR200
14.920
500 m
TSX FP CR500
30.000
100 m
TSX FP CP 100
7.680
500 m
TSX FP CP 500
30.000
In normal environment(2) 3
and inside building
100 m
TSX FP CC100
5.680
200 m
TSX FP CC200
10.920
500 m
TSX FP CC500
30.000
3m
TSX FP CE030
0.410
2m
TSX FP JF020
0.550
8 mm
In normal environment
1 shielded twisted (2)
pair 150
and inside building
2 shielded twisted
pairs
Double fibre optic
62.5/125
(1) The characteristics and performances of the Fipio bus/Fipway network are dependent on the above TSX FP accessories
being used.
(2) Normal environment:
v without special environmental restrictions,
v operating temperature between + 5 C and + 60 C,
v fixed installations.
(3) Harsh environment:
v resistance to hydrocarbons, industrial oils, detergents, solder chips,
v up to 100% humidity,
v saline environment,
v extreme variations in temperature,
v operating temperature between - 10 C and + 70 C,
v mobile installations.
(4) Mobile installations: cables as per VDE 472, part 603/H:
v for use on cable drag chain with minimum bend radius of 75 mm,
v for use on gantry crane (strikethrough: portal support), subject to compliance with conditions for use such as acceleration,
speed, length etc: contact our regional branch office for further information.
v not authorized for use on robots, or multi-axis applications.
4.4
Dimensions
TSX FP ACC6
27
220
205
116
=
50
79
=
50
83
65
80
RUN DEF
25
20
20
RUN DEF
20
104
68
160
50
=
=
20
175
20
TSX FP ACC14
20
80
TSX FP ACC8M
25
TSX FP ACC4
4/59
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
characteristics
Uni-Telway bus
Presentation
The Uni-Telway bus is a standard means of communication between control system
components (PLCs, MMI terminals, supervisors, variable speed drives, numerical
controllers, weighing equipment, etc.).
It is suitable for architectures designed to manage control and monitoring devices via
a PLC, or architectures used for MMI (supervision, etc.).
Premium
The Uni-Telway bus requires a master station which manages the allocation of bus
access rights to the various connected stations (known as slave stations).
Uni-Telway
CCX 17
ATV 58
TSX Micro
Characteristics
Physical interface
Structure
Transmission
4.4
Configuration
Service
Type
Isolated RS 485/
20 mA CL PCMCIA
RS 422 PCMCIA card card
Non-isolated
RS 232D PCMCIA
card
Link
Multidrop
Method of access
Master/Slave principle
Mode
Data rate
1.219.2 Kbit/s
Medium
Number of devices
5 max.
28 max.
Number of connection
addresses
Length of bus
8 max.
10 m max., 1,000 m
with TSX P ACC 01
1300 m max.,
excluding tap links
15 m
(unlimited via modem)
Tap links
20 m
15 m
Uni-TE
Point-to-point requests with confirmation (question/response), of up to 240 bytes (2) initiated by any connected device
Point-to-point
0.319.2 Kbit/s
16 max.
20 m
Unsolicited point-to-point data, without confirmation, of up to 240 bytes(2) initiated by any connected device
Broadcast messages of up to 240 bytes (2) initiated by the master device
Other functions
Transparent communication, via the master, with any device in an X-Way architecture
Diagnostics, debugging, adjustment and programming of PLCs
Security
Monitoring
Check character on each frame, acknowledgement and, if required, repetition of messages ensure security of
transmission
Bus status table, transmission error counters and device status can be accessed by program in each device
Status of the bus and devices connected from the master PLC accessible using PL7 software.
References:
page 4/63
4/60
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics (continued),
description
Uni-Telway bus
Performances
BCT = Bus Cycle Time, is the interval between two polls from the same device.
BCT
(ms)
400
300
200
The curves opposite give the Uni-Telway cycle time as a function of the number of
slaves operating at 9.6 Kbit/s or 19.2Kbit/s, with a typical turnaround time of 5 ms per
device (excluding messages).
100
The following table shows the time to be added (in ms) to obtain the true BCT value
as a function of the traffic (N = Number of usable characters):
1
12
16
20
24
27
1 = 9.6 Kbit/s
2 = 19.2 Kbit/s
Event
Device 1
Report
CT1 CT1
Uni-Telway bus
Time (ms)
at 9.6 Kbit/s
24 + 1.2 N (1)
at 19.2 Kbit/s
17 + 0.6 N (1)
Slave to Master
19 + 1.2 N (1)
12 + 0.6 N (1)
Slave to slave
44 + 2.3 N (1)
29 + 1.15 N (1)
CT1 CT1
BCT
BCT
CT2 CT2
Device 2
Exchanges
Master to slave
Action
This response time must be evaluated by the designer of each application according
to the devices which are connected.
The processing time of a device may vary from one to two cycle times depending on the
degrees of asynchronism.
Description
TSX Micro/Premium PLCs
TSX Micro/Premium PLCs provide various ways of connecting to the Uni-Telway
bus.
4.4
TSX Micro
Premium
Connections:
page 4/62
References:
page 4/63
4/61
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Connections
Uni-Telway bus
12
FT 2100
TSX 17 20
11
TER AUX
Device
10
Adaptor
TSX Micro
(TER terminal port)
9
7
ATV 38/58
1 TSX CSA ppp: bus cable, double shielded twisted pair. The shielding must be
connected to the earth of each device.
2 TSX SCA 50: passive T-junction box, matches the impedance when it is installed
at the end of the line.
3 TSX SCA 62: passive 2-channel Uni-Telway subscriber socket, is used for
coding the address of two connected devices, and matching the impedance when
it is installed at the end of the line.
4 TSX SCA 60/61: passive terminal block, used for intermediate devices that have
a 15-way female SUB D connector:
v TSX SCA 60 used for intermediate devices,
v TSX SCA 61 used for end devices.
5 TSX P ACC 01: connection box, used for connecting a TSX Micro/Premium
PLC to the Uni-Telway bus via the PLC terminal port. The connecting cable
(length 1 m) is integrated in the connection box. It isolates the signals (for
distances >10 m) and is used to match the end of line impedance. It is also used
to set the operation of the terminal port (Uni-Telway Master/Slave or character
mode).
6 TSX LES 64/74: cable connectors for extensions to the Uni-Telway bus, used to
connect TSX model 40 PLC processors that have an integral Uni-Telway port as
standard. They are used for coding the address of the connected device.
7 TSX SCP 114 : PCMCIA card for connecting TSX Micro (1)/Premium PLCs to the
Uni-Telway bus.
8 TSX SCP CU 4030: Uni-Telway connecting cable between the TSX SCP 114
PCMCIA card (on TSX P57 p0M processor or TSX SCY 21601 module) and the
TSX SCA 50 junction box.
9 TSX SCY CU 6530: Uni-Telway connecting cable between the TSX SCY 21601
module integrated channel and the TSX SCA 62 subscriber socket.
10 XBT-Z908: Uni-Telway connecting cable between the CCX 17 and the
TSX SCA 62 subscriber socket.
11 TSX PCX 1031: universal connecting cable between a PC compatible (COM port,
9-way SUB D connector) and the TER or AUX port for TSX Micro/Premium PLCs
or the TSX P ACC 01 connection box (8-way mini-DIN connector).
12 TSX CSC 015: connecting cable between the TSX 17 micro-PLC (via a
TSX 17 ACC 5 adapter or a TSX SCG 1161 module) and TSX SCA 62
subscriber socket.
4.4
TSX DG UTW F: this manual describes the operating principles and the architectures
of the Uni-Telway bus. It is required for setting up and installing the
Uni-Telway bus.
TSX DR NET F: this manual describes the X-Way architectures, services and
address mechanisms. It includes the coding of Uni-TE requests as well as
precautions for connecting earths for the networks. It also includes the principles
of asynchronous serial transmission.
(1) With TSX 37 21/22 PLCs.
Characteristics:
pages 4/60 and 4/61
Description:
page 4/61
References:
page 4/63
4/62
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Uni-Telway bus
TSX Micro
Protocol
Physical layer
Uni-Telway
Non isolated RS 485
Character mode
Communication module
Uni-Telway
1 isolated 2-wire RS 485
Modbus/Jbus
integrated channel
Character mode (channel 0),
1 PCMCIA card slot
(channel 1) (2)
Uni-Telway
RS 232 D (9 signals)
Modbus/Jbus
0.319.2 Kbit/s
Character mode
RS 485 (RS 422
compatible)
1.219.2 Kbit/s
PLC
TSX Micro
Addr. Reference
(1)
Premium
Atrium
Premium
Atrium
20 mA CL
1.219.2 Kbit/s
Weight
kg
0.360
0.105
0.105
0.105
1 CD-Rom
TSX SCP 11 p
TSX P ACC 01
TSX SCA 50
TSX SCA 50
0.520
Passive 2-channel
subscriber socket
TSX SCA 62
0.570
TSX SCA 72
0.520
4.4
Use
From
Uni-Telway bus
Characteristics:
pages 4/60 and 4/61
Weight
kg
0.690
TSX P ACC 01
TSX SCA 72
Addr. Reference
Terminal port connection Isolation of Uni-Telway signals for bus length > 10 m, end 5
box
of line adaptation, bus cable tap links. Supplied with cable
(1 m length) equipped with a mini-DIN connector (TER or
AUX ports)
TSX SCA 62
Use
TSX Micro/
Premium or Atrium
port or
TSX P ACC 01 box
(TER or AUX)
Addr. Length
To
100 m
Reference
(1)
TSX CSA 100
Weight
kg
5.680
200 m
10.920
500 m
30.000
3m
0.160
3m
0.180
3m
0.180
3m
0.200
11
2.5 m
0.170
2.5 m
(1) Product supplied with bilingual Quick Reference Guide: English and French.
(2) Type III PCMCIA type III slot for TSX SCP 111/112/114, TSX FPP 20 or TSX JNP 112/114p card
(3) For information on other connection cables, please see page 4/64.
Description:
page 4/61
Connections:
page 4/62
4/63
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description,
characteristics
Presentation
Premium
TSX Micro
5
1
Description
Integrated links
1 Via integrated port on the processor or coprocessor
The AUX (1) port (8-way mini-DIN connector) has one non-isolated RS 485 serial link
channel (maximum distance 10 m).
2 Via integrated port on the TSX SCY 21601 module
This module for Premium PLCs has one isolated RS 485 serial link channel (25-way
SUB-D connector). Half duplex multiprotocol, including Uni-Telway.
TSX SCP 11p multiprotocol PCMCIA cards
3 A slot on the processor, coprocessor and on the TSX SCY 21601 module takes
cards which comprise:
4 A removable cover with fixing screws for access to the 20-way miniature
connector.
5 Two indicator lamps:
v ERR lamp: card or link fault,
v COM lamp: data transmission or reception.
Connector cable to be ordered separately:
TSX SCP Cp ppp cable.
(1) TER port for TSX Micro TSX 37 05/08/10 PLC.
Characteristics
Type
4.4
Physical layer
Data rate
Transmission
Size
Data
Stop bit
Parity bit
Stop on silence
Reception echo
Repeat 1st char. echo
Auto LF
Back space
Beep
Flow mgmt
by Xon-Xoff
byRTS/CTS
RTS/CTS delay
Stop on reception
End of message
PSR management
Services
Non isolated
Isolated RS 485
RS 485 terminal TSX SCY 21601
port
integrated port
(1)
1.219.2 Kbit/s
1.219.2 Kbit/s
(2)
120 characters
7 or 8 bits
1 or 2 bits
Even, odd or none
PCMCIA cards
RS 232D
0.319.2 Kbit/s
PCMCIA cards
RS 485
RS 422
Compatible
1.219.2 Kbit/s
PCMCIA cards
20 mA current
loop (3)
References:
page 4/59
4/64
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
References
Asynchronous serial link elements (character mode)
Description
Integrated link on
processor
Protocol
Physical layer
PLC
Character mode
Uni-Telway
RS 485
non-isolated
TSX Micro
Premium
RS 232 D (9 signaux)
0,319,2 K bits/s
BC 20 mA
1,219,2 K bits/s
Atrium
Character mode
Uni-Telway
Modbus/Jbus
Weight
kg
TSX Micro
Communication module
Reference
(1)
See page 1/15
Premium
Use
Length
Reference
1m
TSX P ACC 01
Length
Reference
Weight
kg
0.690
Use
From
Cables for isolated RS 485 TSX SCP 114 card
connection
0.180
TSX Micro/Premium/
Atrium port
(TER or AUX) or
TSX P ACC 01 box
RS 232D of a
2.5 m
terminal device (DTE)
(5)
USB port of PC
2.5 m
0.170
Communication
device: modem,
converter, (DCE)
(4)
0.190
Point-to-point
3m
terminal device (DTE)
(4)
10 m
0.190
0.620
0.160
4.4
3m
3m
(1) Product supplied with a bilingual Quick Reference Guide: English and French.
(2) PCMCIA type III slot can receive one TSX SCP 111/112/114, TSX FPP 20 or
TSX JNP 112/114 card.
(3) End of cable fitted with flying leads.
(4) End of cable fitted with a 25-way male SUB-D connector.
(5) End of cable fitted with a 9-way male SUB-D connector. For use, to order separatly one
TSX CTC 10 adaptator (9-way male SUB-D connector/25-way male SUB-D connectors).
Presentation:
page 4/58
3m
Integrated channel
(channel 0) module
TSX SCY 21601
TSX P ACC 01
Cable for BC 20 mA
connection
3m
Weight
kg
TSX SCP CX 4030
0.160
To
RS 485/RS 422
device
(3)
RS 485/RS 422
device (4) via
TSX SCA 50 box
Description:
page 4/58
Characteristics:
page 4/58
4/65
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Protocol
Length
Reference
Character mode
3m
Weight
kg
TSX SCP CD 1030
0.190
10 m
0.620
DCE terminal
(Modem...) 2
RS 232D
Character mode
Uni-Telway
3m
0.190
TSX SCA 50
T-junction box
3
RS 485
Character mode
(2-wire isolated) Uni-Telway
3m
0.160
RS 422/485
Character mode
(2-wire isolated) Modbus
3m
0.160
TSX SCA 62
2-channel
subscriber
socket 4
RS 485
Uni-Telway
(2-wire isolated)
3m
0.160
TSX SCA 64
2-channel
subscriber
socket 4
RS 422/485
(2/4 wire)
Modbus
3m
0.180
Modbus
3m
0.160
Active or
passive
terminal 3
Character mode
Uni-Telway
Modbus
3m
0.160
TER/AUX ports
Uni-Telway
1m
Uni-Telway
2m
0.100
5m
0.190
0.170
4.4
20 mA current
loop
DTE terminal
(PC, printer) 6
RS 232
Character mode
2,5 m
RS 232
Character mode
2,5 m
4
5
6
7
4/66
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References (continued)
Protocol
Length
Reference
Uni-Telway
2.5 m
Weight
kg
0.170
Uni-Telway
2.5 m
Character mode
Uni-Telway
2.5 m
Character mode
Uni-Telway
2.5 m
Character mode
Uni-Telway
3m
0.140
Uni-Telway
2.5 m
XBT Z968
0.180
3 RS 232
RS 485
TSX SCA 50
RS 485
Uni-Telway
T-junction box 6 (2-wire isolated)
Modbus/Jbus
TSX SCA 62
2-channel
subscriber
socket 7
0.170
RS 485
Uni-Telway
(2-wire isolated)
5m
XTB Z9681
0.340
3m
0.180
3m
0.180
3m
0.200
4.4
RS 485
terminal 6
RS 485
Character mode
(2-wire isolated)
3m
0.180
Separate parts
Description
SUB-D adapter
Description
Reference
4
5
6
7
TSX CTC 10
Weight
kg
0.060
0.060
(1) To be ordered separatly: TSX CTC 07 and TSX CTC 10 adapters, see above separate parts.
(2) Point to point, supplied wih 1 SUB-D adapter: TSX CTC 09 9-way female/25-way male SUB-D connector.
4/67
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
5/0
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Contents
5/1
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection guide
Programming softwares
Applications
Type of PLC
TSX Micro
Services
Programming
Debugging
Adjustment
Instruction list
Ladder language
Grafcet language
Structured text language
DFBs function blocks
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Fonctional view
Import/export od function modules
Diagnostic DFBs
Runtime screens
Functions
No
No
No
TSX Micro/Premium/Atrium
Name of software
PL7 Micro
PL7 Junior
PL7 Pro
Type of software
Pages
5/18
5/19
5/2
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Application conversion
Development of functions in
C language
Development of a multi-PLC
data server
Premium/Atrium
Nano/TSX Micro/
Premium/Atrium
Quantum/Momentum/
TSX Series 7/April
Automatic comparison of 2
Premium applications with
identification of all the
differences.
Continuity of operation in a
Premium PLC redundant
architecture automate
Premium.
Possible to have shared I/O
on a Fipio bus or redundant
I/O
Typical Normal/Backup
changeover time: 1 to 2 s
Development of a multi-PLC
data server accessible by
Client applications:
b Access to server in local
or remote mode.
b Access to variables in the
form of symbols in one or
more PLCs.
b Management of Uni-TE
and Modbus protocols.
b Programming in Visual
Basic or C++.
b Simulates access to
variables for debugging.
PL7 SMC
PL7 SDKC
PL7 DIF
Warm Standby
OFS
5/21
5/25
5/23
Other software:
v PL7 FUZ, software for fuzzy logic processing for TSX Micro/Premium platforms: TLX L PL7 FUZ 34 M, see page 5/27.
v SyCon, CANopen machine bus configuraor (TSX Micro/Premium) and INTERBUS fieldbus (Quantum) and Profibus DP (Premium/Quantum):
SYS SPU LFp CD28M, see page 4/25.
5/3
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Offer,
new developments
CANopen connectivity
Micro TSX 37 21 and 37 22 PLC communications are enriched with the addition of
a CANopen machine bus, made possible through the use of a PCMCIA card
equipped with a cable (length 0.5m) and a tap junction (with 9-way SUB-D
connector). This TSX CPP 110 kit allows a direct link to the bus and ensures the
role of the master on the CANopen bus. The PCMCIA card is inserted into the
reserved communication card slot that is available on the TSX 37 21 and
TSX 37 22 CPU.
Extension memory size
In order to extend the memory of existing applications or to create more complex
applications, the memory capacity of TSX 37 21/22 PLCs can be extended from
64 Kwords to 128 Kwords (program and constants). The CPU bases are capable of
receiving 3 different memory cards:
b 128 Kwords application RAM memory TSX MRP 0128P.
b 128 Kwords application Flash EPROM memory TSX MRF 0128P.
b 128 Kwords application and 128 Kwords data storage RAM memory
TSX MRP 2128P.
CANopen connectivity
b The Premium TSX P57 103M low-end processor has CANopen machine bus
connectivity via the use of the new TSX CPP 110 PCMCIA card (see CANopen
connectivity for TSX Micro platform, above). This new card is compatible with all
Premium processors and Atrium coprocessors (except TSX P57 153M processor
with embedded Fipio bus link).
New application-specific modules:
b TSX CSY 164 SERCOS motion control module. PL7 version 4.4 Junior/Pro
software makes it possible for this module to individually declare the 16 channels
as real axes, imaginary axes or remote axes. This new 16-channel module is in
addition to the current TSX CSY 84 module with 8 real axes.
b TSX WMY 100 FactoryCast HMI Ethernet module. This new Ethernet TCP/IP
module with embedded Web server offers additional HMI web services compared
to current modules (TSX ETH 110WS/4103/5103). New features include acquisition
of PLC data in the HMI database of the module, Email with automatic messaging
on events, math and logic functions, and connection to relational databases.
PL7 version 4.4 enables new TSX Micro/Premium modules to take advantage of
additional functionalities:
b PL7 software registrations by the Internet, electronic mail, fax or phone
(obligatory registration before 22nd day).
b Change in the Fipio catalogue for Momentum distributed I/O.
b Transfer of PL7 user rights between PCs via floppy disk or network.
b Enriched export files of the data application (FEF) for better compatibility with
Unity software after migration.
PL7 Micro Junior/Pro software packages are offered according to two alternatives
depending on the type of PLCs/PC cable: connection on the RS 232C port, or the
USB port of a PC.
Presentation:
page 5/5
Setup, language:
pages 5/6 to 5/11
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
Reference:
pages 5/17 to 5/19
5/4
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation
Presentation
PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro software packages are designed for Windows 2000
Professional and Windows XP (1) operating systems and therefore benefit from all
the facilities relating to these:
Ergonomics of the software
More user-friendly and productive ergonomics thanks to:
b Access to contextual menus by right-clicking with the mouse for fast access to the
services available for the select ed object.
b Contextual help: direct access to help correspondingto the selected object.
b Tool tips: explanatory messages appear when skimming over the toolbar buttons.
Furthermore, some important functions make the software easier and safer to use:
Multi-instance
The multi-instance function enables several applications to be worked on
simultaneously.
This function enables:
b Several different applications present on the PC to be opened in offline mode in
order to check or copy data.
b Debugging of two (or more) applications on two PLCs present on the same
network in on-line mode. This is particularly useful when debugging inter-PLC
communication functions.
Automation
OLE
Terminal PC
Serveur
Automation
Applicatifs
Client
OLE
Terminal PC
Client
PL7
Fipway
Premium
TSX Micro
Application server
PL7 Pro software can be launched in OLE Automation server mode from a third-party
client application. In this case, certain PL7 program functions can be executed
following commands sent by an OLE client application. This instance of the program
then no longer reacts to commands from the operator keyboard. Server mode can
be launched in offline mode (COM) if both programs are on the same machine, or in
remote mode (DCOM), if the programs are installed on different machines.
The commands available are as follows:
b Manage an execution context (open/close an application, modification of the
address and driver of the connected PLC; PLC status).
b Control the PLC (connection/disconnection, send a RUN/STOP/INIT command,
program uploading/downloading).
b Read data (application or symbol export only in source format, read
symbol/comment associated with an address, read application identity).
(1) However, compatibility with the Windows 95 operating system is no longer provided and USB
port is not compatible with Windows 95 and Windows NT 4.0.
Setup, language:
pages 5/6 to 5/11
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
Reference:
pages 5/18 to 5/19
5/5
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Setup
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Configuration editor.
Program editor.
DFB user function block editor.
Variable editor.
Animation table editor.
Documentation editor.
Operating screen editor.
5
6
7
2
3
PL7 Pro software can be used to structure an application for a Premium platform into
functional modules that are broken down into sections (program code), animation
tables and operating screens. Independently of the multitask structure of the PLC, the
designer can define a multilevel tree structure of the automation application.
At each level, it is possible to attach program sections written in Ladder language (LD),
Structured Text (ST), Instruction List (IL), Grafcet (SFC), and animation tables.
Two types of view are available at all times:
b A representation showing a tree structure of modules can provide a breakdown
according to consistent functions in relation to the process to control.
b The classic representation of the application browser provides a view of the
execution order of the program sections for each PLC.
The operation services associated with the functional view are available in one or
the other view. In particular, a single command can be used to force whether or not
a functional module is executed.
In this case, every section attached to the functional module is automatically forced.
All or part of the tree structure can be exported into functional modules.
In this case, all program sections of the different module levels are exported.
During an import, an assistant can be used to reassign the data associated with the
module in stages.
Presentation:
page 5/5
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
Reference:
pages 5/18 to 5/19
5/6
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Setup (continued)
Configuration editor
Hardware configuration
The configuration editor intuitively and graphically enables the declaration and
configuration of the various components of the TSX Micro/Premium PLC application:
b Processor, coprocessor.
b Tasks.
b Application-specific I/O modules.
b Memory.
b ...
By clicking on an unconfigured position, the display of a dialog box shows the
available I/O modules, classed according to family.
Once the various modules are positioned, selecting them accesses parameter entry
for each module.
Software configuration
The configuration editor can also be used to set the software parameters of the
application: choice of the number of constants, number of internal words and the
number of each type of function block.
The configuration editor provides access to parameter entry for the function blocks.
The copy/paste function for these parameters is available from version u V4.0 of the
PL7 software onwards.
Configuration of Grafcet objects
When programming in Grafcet language, the configuration editor can define Grafcet
objects (steps, macro-steps, etc.) and execution parameters (number of steps and
active transitions).
Setup of application-specific functions
A number of tools are provided as standard for setting up the various applications:
discrete I/O, analog I/O, counting, motion control (1), man-machine interface (MMI),
communication, weighing (1), Warm Standby redundancy (2).
The parameter screens for the application-specific functions are accessed from the
I/O configuration screen by clicking on the position in which the module has been
defined.
The screens enable the main operating characteristics of the chosen application to be
defined, for example:
b
b
b
b
b
b
Presentation:
page 5/5
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
Reference:
pages 5/18 to 5/19
5/7
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Software structure
Software structure
PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro software offers two types of structure:
b Single task: this is the simplified structure offered by default, where a single master
task consisting of a main program, comprising several sections and subroutines, is
executed.
b Multitask: this structure, which is better suited to high-performance real-time
applications, consists of a master task, a fast task and event-triggered tasks, which
have the highest priority. Master and fast tasks are divided into sections.
Structured and modular programming
Mast
Fast
Sas(LD)
Alarm_Sas(LD)
Furnace_1(Grafcet)
Safety_Mon(LD)
PRE(LD)
CHART
Alarm_Furnace(ST)
POST(IL)
Alarm_Cleaning(ST)
SR0
PL7 program tasks comprise several parts called sections and subroutines. Each
section can be programmed in the appropriate language for the processing to be
carried out.
Such division into sections enables a structured program to be created and program
modules can easily be generated or added.
SR0
Subroutines can be called from any section of the task to which they belong or from
other subroutines in the same task.
Cleaning(ST)
RUN
STOP
Program
processing
At the end of each scan, the PLC system launches the execution of a new scan.
The execution time of each scan is monitored by a software watchdog whose value
is defined by the user.
In the event of overrun, a fault occurs causing:
b The scan to stop immediately (STOP).
b A display on the front panel of the PLC.
b The alarm relay of the main rack power supply to be set to 0.
Update of
outputs (%O)
Periodic execution
Launch
of the period
Input acquisition
(%I)
RUN
STOP
Program
processing
A new scan is executed at the end of each period. The execution time of the scan must
be less than the time of the period defined (1 to 255 ms). In the event of overrun, the
latter is stored in a system bit (%S19), which can be set to 0 by the user (by program
or by the terminal).
A software watchdog which can be configured by the user monitors the scan time. In
the event of overrun, an execution fault is signaled (see normal execution).
Update of
outputs (%O)
Internal
processing
End of period
Presentation:
page 5/5
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
Reference:
pages 5/18 to 5/19
5/8
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
automation platform
Master task
Alarm_Sas(LD)
Sas(LD)
Safety_Mon(LD)
Furnace_1(LD)
PRE(LD)
Alarm_Furnace(ST)
Alarm_Cleaning(ST)
SR0
CHART
POST(IL)
SR0
Drying(LD)
Priority + ...
This structure can optimize use of the processing power, and can be used to
structure the application and simplify design and debugging, as it is possible to write
and debug each task independently of the others.
Master task
This compulsory task, which executes the main program, is periodic or cyclic (see
single task structures). It is activated systematically. It is intended for sequential
processing. Each section can be programmed in Ladder, Structured Text or
Instruction List language. One section is dedicated to Grafcet language; when this
language is chosen, 3 processing operations are proposed:
b Preliminary processing (PRE) is programmed in Ladder, Structured Text or
Instruction List language and processes initializations on power return, operating
mode modifications, input logic.
b Sequential processing (CHART) includes the graphic transcription and
management of Grafcet charts. It provides access to processing of the actions and
transition conditions.
b Post-processing (POST). This is programmed in Ladder, Structured Text or
Instruction List language and is used to process all the instructions from the
2 preceding processing operations and the indirect safety functions specific to the
outputs.
Fast task
This task, which is higher priority than the master task, is periodic in order to leave
time for execution of the lower priority task. Processing operations in this task must be
as short as possible so as not to adversely affect the master task. It is useful when fast
periodic changes in discrete inputs need to be monitored.
Each section of this task can be programmed in Ladder, Structured Text or
Instruction List language.
Event triggered tasks
Unlike the tasks described above, these tasks are not linked to a period. Their
execution is triggered by an event occurring in an application-specific module (eg.:
overrun of a counter threshold, change in state of a discrete input). These tasks have
higher priority than all other tasks, and they are therefore suitable for processing
operations requiring very short response times to the occurrence of an event.
They can be programmed in Ladder, Structured Text or Instruction List language.
Number of EVTi control events:
b TSX Micro PLCs: 8 events with TSX 37 10 and 16 events with TSX 37 21/22.
b Premium PLCs: 32 events with TSX 57 10 and 64 events with TSX 57 20/30/40
and PCX 57 20/30.
TSX Micro TSX 37 21/22 and Premium PLCs have 2 priority levels (EVT0 event has
priority over other EVTi events).
Presentation:
page 5/5
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
Reference:
pages 5/18 to 5/19
5/9
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Ladder language,
structured text language
Presentation:
page 5/5
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
Reference:
pages 5/18 to 5/19
5/10
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Grafcet language,
Instruction List language
Premium PLC
b maximum of 250 steps on
8 pages
b 64 macro-steps of 250
steps.
b A "generic" comment can
be associated with each
macro-step
b 1024 transitions maximum
b 11 elements maximum per
divergence/ convergence
b 1024 steps maximum in
the application
Presentation:
page 5/5
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
Reference:
pages 5/18 to 5/19
5/11
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions
Functions
User DFB function blocks
PL7 Pro software offers the user the possibility (for Premium PLCs) of creating their
own function blocks which meet the particular needs of their applications. Once they
have been created in the library, these function blocks can be used with PL7
Junior/Pro software.
These user function blocks enable an application to be structured. They are used as
soon as a program sequence is repeated several times in the application or to freeze
a standard type of programming. They can be exported to all other PL7 applications.
Using a DFB function block in one or more applications enables:
b Simplification of program entry and design.
b Improved program readability.
b Easier debugging (all variables handled by the DFB function block are identified
on its interface).
b Use of DFB-specific internal variables (independent of the application).
A DFB derived function block is set up in three phases:
b Design of the DFB which has a name, parameters (I/O), variables and code in
Structured Text or ladder language.
b Creation of a DFB instance in the variables editor or when calling the function in
the program editor.
b Using this instance in the program in the same way as a standard function block.
Variables editor
The variables editor is used to:
b Symbolize the various application objects (bits, words, function blocks, I/O, ).
b Define the parameters of the predefined function blocks (timers, counters,
registers etc.).
b Enter the values of the constants and select the display base (decimal, binary,
hexadecimal, floating point, message).
b Define the DFB user function block parameters.
Each symbol (32 characters max, accented characters are permitted) can be
accompanied by a comment (508 characters max).
Editing services are available in the editor:
b Find/replace an object in a part of the program or in a set of function modules
(PL7 Pro).
b Find a character string in a list of symbols or comments.
Version u V4.0 of PL7 offers enhanced functions due to:
b Copy/paste function for one or more symbol(s) and comments.
b Display in plain language of the overlap of different types of variable on a single
memory address (for example, single and double format internal words,
%MW0/%MD0).
b Highlighting of objects used by the application program.
b Opening the application variable database to third-party tools by
importing/exporting text files (.txt). This new function makes it possible to
create/modify application databases using a third-party software (for example
TSX Microsoft Excel) that has extended edit functions.
Animation table
Tables containing the application variables to be monitored or modified can be
created by entering them or automatically initialized from the selected phrase or
rung.
Variables can then be:
b Modified.
b Forced to 0 or 1 for bit objects.
For each numerical variable, it is possible to select the display base (decimal, binary,
hexadecimal, floating point, ASCII message).
Version u V4.0 of PL7 offers new options for animation tables:
b Display of the comment associated with variables.
b Assignment of a single value to a number of variables.
b Change of display format for a number of variables.
b Display of the list of forced bits.
Presentation:
page 5/5
Setup, language:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
Reference:
pages 5/18 to 5/19
5/12
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions (continued)
Documentation editor
The documentation editor is built around the Documentation Browser which displays
the contents of the documentation file in a tree structure.
It can be used to print all or part of the application documentation file on any graphic
printer which can be accessed in Windows and uses True Type technology, in A4 or
US letter print formats.
The documentation editor is used to define:
b A title page, including the name of the designer and project.
b General information pages.
b A footer.
Runtime screens
The runtime screen tool is integrated in PL7 Pro software (creation and use of
screens). It is intended in particular, for debugging when starting up installations and
for diagnostics on faults or malfunctions.
It comprises data (explanatory texts, dynamic values, synoptics, etc.) and enables a
simple and fast action (modification and dynamic monitoring of PLC variables).
The editor enables the design of these screens using the following tools:
b Screen: creation of runtime screens, which can be classed according to family.
b Message: creation of messages used.
b Objects: creation of a graphic objects library.
When the station is connected to the PLC, the user can display screens dynamically
depending on the state of the process.
Screen sequencing is possible, depending on the attributed priority, via either the
keyboard or PLC request.
In online mode, runtime screens enable direct access to the PL7 program from
synoptics by simply clicking on the selected object.
It is also possible to activate the animation table functions or cross references once
one or more variables have been selected on the screen. Version u V4.0 of PL7
software also enables character string type objects to be displayed.
Synoptics can be displayed on the full screen for ease of viewing.
Presentation:
page 5/5
Setup, language:
pages 5/6 to 5/11
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/17
Reference:
pages 5/18 to 5/19
5/13
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions (continued)
Debugging tools
PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro software offers a complete set of tools for debugging
applications. A tool palette provides direct access to the main functions:
b Setting stop points.
b Step by step program execution.
b Independent execution of the master (MAST), fast (FAST) and event-triggered
(EVTi) tasks.
Grafcet debugging
In online mode, the browser gives a hierarchical view of the chart with CHART
module and macro-step nesting. Animation is characterized by the presence or
absence of indicator colors.
The Grafcet debug bar:
b Displays the state of the chart.
b Modifies the state of the chart.
b Gives information on the state of the Master task.
Debugging the application-specific functions
The debug screens for the application-specific functions are accessed from the I/O
configuration screen by clicking on the position in which the module has been
defined, when the terminal is in online mode.
These screens are used for:
b Displaying and modifying the state of the I/O.
b Forcing the I/O.
b Displaying and modifying the current values.
b ...
Diagnostics
The debug screens provide access to the general module or channel diagnostics.
These screens identify:
Internal module faults.
b External faults from the application.
b E.g.: range overrun fault for an analog module.
With version u V4.0 of PL7 software, the Premium platform system diagnostics are
extended. It is possible to monitor system bits and words as well as to display
associated time-stamped messages automatically, without the need for additional
programming. This monitoring applies to the system elements (processor,
memory,tasks, ), in-rack I/O and remote I/O on the Fipio bus.
Presentation:
page 5/5
Setup, language:
pages 5/6 to 5/11
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
Reference:
pages 5/18 to 5/19
5/14
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions (continued)
Variable cross-references
For every variable, this function can be used to:
b Search for program modules where this variable is used.
b Obtain the list of statements, rungs or expressions.
b Display and check activation conditions.
A log is used to keep track of this navigation.
Options relating to the variable, can be associated with the search (extract bit, table
object, function block elements, network object, etc.).
This function can be initialized from the program or runtime screens.
Application converters
PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro software includes application converters which make it
possible to reuse in full or in part, applications already written in:
b PL7 2, applications for TSX 17, TSX 27 or TSX 47 10/20/25 PLCs.
b PL7 3 (1), applications for TSX/PMX 47...TSX/PMX 107 PLCs.
b ORPHEE (1), applications for April Series 1000 PLCs.
The converters offer the following utilities:
b Translation of language objects into the new PL7 syntax with retrieval of
associated symbols and comments.
b Possibility of manually reassigning objects.
b Configuration check: the tool checks whether the configuration resources required
by the program to be converted are compatible with the configuration of the
destination application.
b Conversion (1) with generation of source files (Ladder, Structured Text or Grafcet)
in PL7 Junior/Pro format.
b Conversion ensures that instructions which are translated are functionally identical
to the original program.
b A translation report gives a summary:
v result of the conversion with the cause of non-translation where possible,
v correspondence of variables in PL7 with original variables.
Windows XP
Windows 2000
V1.6 IE17
V1.3 IE05
V1.2 IE03
V1.1 IE04
V1.1 IE02
V1.2 IE04
V1.0 IE06
V1.7 IE13
V1.1 IE06
Inclus PL7
Uni-Telway
TSX FPC10
TSX FPC20
TSX SCP 114
Ethway
ISAway
PCIway
XIP
Modbus
USB for mini-DIN terminal
port
USB for USB terminal port V1.0 IE14
Windows NT
Windows 95
OS/2
DOS
V1.9 IE17
V1.3 IE08
V1.3 IE08
V1.1 IE04
V1.1 IE03
V1.5 IE06
V1.7 IE13
V1.1 IE06
Windows 98
Millenium
V1.6 IE17
V1.3 IE05
V1.2 IE04
V1.1 IE04
V2.6 IE06
V1.2 IE04
V1.7 IE13
V1.1 IE06
V7.8 IE18
V2.4 IE14
V1.2 IE04
V1.1 IE04
V2.6 IE06
V1.2 IE09
V1.7 IE13
V1.1 IE06
V2.4 IE13
V1.5 IE05
V2.6 IE22
V7.4 IE14
V2.2 IE11
Presentation:
page 5/5
Setup, language:
pages 5/6 to 5/11
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
Reference:
pages 5/17 to 5/19
5/15
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Characteristics
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
Word objects
Indexed objects
Structured objects
Presentation:
page 5/5
Setup, language:
pages 5/6 to 5/11
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Reference:
pages 5/17 to 5/19
5/16
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection
Selection
The selection table shown below can be used to define the most suitable
programming software in terms of services that are required and the
TSX Micro/Premium automation platforms used.
Utilities/functions
Programming software
Languages
Instruction List
Ladder language
Grafcet
Grafcet macro-steps
Structured Text
DFB function blocks
Creation
Operation
Display
Functional views
Application
Function modules
Creation
Operation
DFB function blocks for application diagnostics
Creation
Operation
Display
Diagnostics viewer
Runtime screens
Creation
Operation
Application converters
PL7 2
PL7 3
Orphee
Software extensions
SMC (converter)
SDKC (C language dev)
PL7 DIF (comparison of PL7 applications)
PL7 FUZ (sofware for fuzzy logic processing)
OFS (data server)
WSBY (Warm Standby redundancy)
Sycon (fieldbus configurator)
PL7
TSX
TSX
TSX
Micro
Micro
Micro
Micro
TSX Micro
PL7 Junior
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
PL7 Pro
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
Premium
Premium
Premium
Premium
Premium
Premium
Premium
Premium
Premium
Premium
Premium
Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro
TSX Micro
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
TSX Micro/Premium
Premium
CANopen
CANopen, Profibus DP
References
Multilingual software packages (English, French, German, Spanish and Italian) for
PC compatibles (1) equipped with Windows 98, Windows NT 4.0, Windows
Millennium, Windows 2000 Professional or Windows XP operating systems.
For one station, these packages comprise:
b A CD-ROM supporting the PL7 multilingual software, the PL7 demonstration
applications and the terminal link Uni-Telway driver.
b A cable reference TSX PCU 1031, PC compatible with TSX Micro/Premium PLC
(length 2.5 m). Not supplied with software upgrade or update packages and PL7
software licenses.
b Two CD-ROMs containing multilingual technical documentation.
b A CD-ROM containing the TSX Micro/Premium platform operating systems.
For packages for 3 stations, the above quantities are multiplied by three. For software
licenses, TSX PCX 1031 cables must be ordered separately, according to the required
number of users.
All documentation reference (software setup manuals) reference TLX DOC PL7 43F
should be ordered separately.
(1) Typical recommended configuration: Pentium processor, 266 MHz, 128 Mb of RAM memory,
CD-ROM drive for installation of the PL7 program, VGA screen or above.
Presentation:
page 5/5
Setup, language:
pages 5/6 to 5/11
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
5/17
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
For PLC
Type of device
and update
Single (1 station)
Reference
(1)
TLX CD PL7M p44M
Group (3 stations)
Single (1 station)
Single (1 station)
Group (3 stations)
Software update
for previous
version of
PL7 Micro
supplied with
SyCon V2.8
Single (1 station)
PL7 Micro
TSX Micro
software packages
Weight
kg
TSX Micro
For PLCs
Single (1 station)
Reference
(1)
TLX CD PL7J p44M
Group (3 stations)
Single (1 station)
Group (3 stations)
Single (1 station)
Group (3 stations)
PL7 Junior
TSX Micro,
software packages Premium,
Atrium PCX
Type
Weight
kg
(1) p in reference, defines the type of connecting cable PC/PLC (length 2.5 m)
v P: TSX PCX 1031 cable for RS 232C port of PC,
v PU: TSX PCX 3030 cable for USB port of PC.
Presentation:
page 5/5
Setup, language:
pages 5/6 to 5/11
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
5/18
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References (continued)
For PLCs
Type
Single (1 station)
Reference
(1)
TLX CD PL7P p44M
Group (3 stations)
Single (1 station)
Group (3 stations)
Single (1 station)
Group (3 stations)
Type
Reference
Weight
kg
Client/server network
TLX S PL7P P44M
architecture server device.
Use of the PL7 Pro via client
station (Thin client) on network
and with access rights.
PL7 Pro
software package
Software upgrade
packages from previous
versions of PL7 Junior
Weight
kg
For PLCs
Separated elements
Description
Use
Reference
X-Way drivers package for Includes all X-Way drivers (see page 5/15)
compatible PC
Includes multilingual user documentation.
Description
Universal terminal port
cable
TLX CD DRV20M
Weight
kg
to PC port
Length
Reference
Mini-DIN port
TSX Micro/Premium
RS 232D
(15-way
SUB-D
connector)
2.5 m
Weight
kg
0.170
USB Port
2.5 m
0.150
Description
Reference
Weight
kg
3.410
(1) p in reference, defines the type of connecting cable PC/PLC (length 2.5 m)
v P: TSX PCX 1031 cable for RS 232C port of PC,
v PU: TSX PCX 3030 cable for USB port of PC.
(2) Team user stations from the same geographical site.
Presentation:
page 5/5
Setup, language:
pages 5/6 to 5/11
Functions:
pages 5/12 to 5/15
Characteristics:
pages 5/16 to 5/18
5/19
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
setup
Presentation
The application converter software for SMC PLCs is a PL7 Junior and PL7 Pro
software option. It enables parts of, or in certain cases, the entire existing SMC PLC
application to be reused with Micro/Premium PLCs. The converter generates
instructions in PL7 language which are functionally identical to the original
instructions.
If the application has been archived using VPSOFT programming software (version
3.02 minimum) for SMC PLCs, it is possible to translate the program and comments
and retrieve the entire database (variable symbols and comments). If this is not the
case, the program only can still be converted once it has been transferred with
VPSOFT software. Program conversion is possible for SMC 200/500, SMC 23/35
and SMC 50/600 PLC applications.
The SMC converter provides the following functions:
b Selection of the application in the directory where SMC applications are stored.
b Selection of the program to be converted: sequences to be converted.
b Code and data analysis: associations are suggested for SMC variables with PL7
correspondence (bits, words, double words or reals).
b Code and variable conversion in order to generate a PL7 equivalent.
b Report which shows the user the conversion success rate, associations and
causes of non-conversion when applicable.
b Target configuration for displaying or entering a configuration required for
arranging variables in PL7.
It is possible to convert only the SMC database.
Software setup
Once installed, the SMC converter is activated from PL7 (File/Convert command).
Translated program modules are converted into an importable source format in a
new PL7 application or in the current application.
Functions:
page 5/21
Reference:
page 5/21
5/20
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Functions,
reference
Functions
Database conversion
The converter is extremely easy to use. All or part of the symbolised database can
be retrieved. Its reassignment services operate on individual data or blocks of data
addresses.
I/O reassignment:
The converter in particular enables discrete I/O variables from an SMC PLC to be
directly reassigned by module to TSX Micro/Premium PLC modules. It is also
possible to merge objects from several SMC modules into a single Premium module
(when using-modules with 64 channels for example).
Program conversion
The SMC sequential program conversion can be carried out on the entire program
or on a selected part of the program. The result of the conversion is a PL7 format
source file which can be imported into any task written in Ladder language.
Once an analysis phase is completed, the software offers default correspondence
and requests additional information when necessary.
A conversion report provides the following information:
b Result of the conversion for each instruction with the cause of non-conversion if
applicable.
b List of variable correspondence before and after conversion, including I/O
reassignment.
Reference
This software extension conforms to SMC PLC application conversion requirements
using PL7 Junior and PL7 Pro setup software. It comprises:
b A set of 3"1/2 disks.
b A multilingual user manual (English, French and Spanish).
Logiciel convertisseur d'applications pour automates SMC
Description Function
PL7 SMC
application
converter
software
Facilitates conversion of
SMC 200/500 and
SMC 25/35/50/600
applications to PL7
applications. Converts
sequential information into
Ladder language and data
Target PLC
extension
PL7 Junior/Pro
Micro/Premium
Reference
Weight
kg
TLX LC SMC PL7 40M
0.560
Rererence, setup:
page 5/20
5/21
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
setup
Presentation
PL7 DIF application comparison software for Premium platforms is an optional
program which complements the PL7 Pro programming software. It is used to
compare two PL7 applications generated by PL7 Pro and automatically provide an
exhaustive list of all the differences between them.
The PL7 DIF program increases productivity in the main life phases of a control
system based on a Premium platform:
b Application development and debugging.
b Starting up installations and processes.
b Operation and maintenance of installations and processes.
PL7 DIF software is an efficient tool for handling PL7 applications for:
b Control system design offices.
b Operation and maintenance managers.
b Installers and systems integrators.
Software setup
The PL7 DIF software can be used in one of two modes:
b Interactive mode, when the comparison is launched by an operator command
(double-click on the PL7Diff software icon).
b Batch mode, when it is launched by a previously established call command.
These comparison commands locate all the differences between two applications in
terms of:
b
b
b
b
b
b
b
The result of the comparison between the two applications can be:
b Displayed.
b Printed.
b Saved in .txt format in a differences list.
Comparison
The end of the comparison operation is signalled by the appearance of the
application browser with its three tabs.
1 Identification tab for accessing the characteristics of the two applications being
compared. The differences are marked by the sign #.
2 Browser tab for accessing the application multilevel tree structure.
References:
page 5/23
5/22
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Setup (continued),
references
Setup (continued)
Display of results
The representation of the application multilevel tree structure, which can be
accessed via the browser tab after launching a comparison, is annotated by
4 symbols in which the information associated with application 1 appear in blue and
those associated with application 2 appear in red:
This branch, found in this level of the tree structure, contains at least
one difference
This block contains at least one difference
1
2
References
This software extension can be used to compare two PL7 applications generated by
PL7 Pro and designed for TSX Micro/Premium platforms. It comprises one CD-Rom
(three disks), containing the PL7 DIF software with its documentation (English and
French). A software subscription is available for this extension (please consult your
Regional Sales Office).
PL7 DIF application comparison software
Function
Target
extension PLC
target
Using for comparing
PL7 Pro
applications generated TSX Micro/
by PL7 Pro version u V4 Premium
Type of device
Reference
Weight
kg
1 station
3 stations
Presentation:
page 5/22
5/23
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
setup
SDKC software
Presentation
C language function development software, also called SDKC, is a PL7 Micro,
PL7 Junior and PL7 Pro software option. It enables new functions to be developed
(internal code written in C language) and extends and completes the standard set of
functions offered by PL7 software.
SDKC software also integrates a creation and management service for families of
functions, so they can be integrated in the PL7 library.
Finally, it can be used to generate the function which ensures the protection of
PL7 applications by reading a signature in the PCMCIA card inserted in the PLC.
Setup
C language development software is a genuine tool for managing the entire function
which has been created:
b A user-friendly creation interface, integrated in PL7, with automatic file
organisation.
b Powerful debug and test tools.
b Management of compatibility and software version for the functions created.
b Generation of disks for the subsequent installation of functions on other
development stations.
Management of function families
The software enables different function families to be defined. These functions, also
known as EF, are classed according to family, allowing the user to create a
sequential library of functions written in C language.
These functions, which will eventually form a part of the PL7 library, can be:
b Used in all languages.
b Displayed by the PL7 library tool.
b Classed according to family/function.
Editing functions
The various SDKC software editor tabs enable the user to create the function by:
b Declaring the interface (name, type and comment) for each input, output or I/O
parameter.
b Writing the source code file in C language.
b Declaring the constants as separate files.
A function written in C language can access numerous internal PLC services such
as real-time clock, PLC variables, system words, mathematical functions.
In particular, it is possible to carry out numerical processing in floating point format,
if the target PLC allows.
Reference:
page 5/25
5/24
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Setup (continued),
reference
SDKC software
Setup (continued)
Debugging the functions
The function created must be generated under the debug format to be tested.
Once it has been inserted in an application and loaded to a PLC, the execution of a
function can be checked using numerous debug tools.
A specific function debug menu in C language accesses the following services:
b
b
b
b
Breakpoint insertion.
Step by step execution.
Display of code with breakpoints shown.
Display of data manipulations.
Reference
This software extension enables standard functions offered by PL7 Micro, PL7 Junior
and PL7 Pro version > V4 software to be extended.
It comprises:
b A set of 3"1/2 disks.
b A bilingual user manual (English and French).
This software is supplied with a Microsoft Visual C++ software package registration
card.
PL7 SDKC procedure creation software
Description
Function
Target PLC
extension
PL7 SDKC software Procedure written in PL7 Micro/
extension
C language with
Junior/Pro
access to floating
TSX Micro/
point functions
Premium
Debug in PLC
Reference
Weight
kg
0.930
TLX L SDKC PL7 41M
Presentation:
page 5/24
5/25
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
setup
Presentation
PL7 FUZ software is a PL7 TSX Micro/Junior/Pro software option enabling fuzzy
logic processing in order to optimise the control of processes from Micro and
Premium PLCs. This is a software function which can be integrated in any
PL7 program. lt includes setup and debug tools.
This function is particularly suitable for controlling:
b Systems which are difficult to model or non-linear systems, with wide variation of
inputs or an insufficient sensor resolution.
b Systems which are difficult to control and require experience and human intuition.
It enables:
b Boolean logic limits to be exceeded (true or false state).
b The representation of physical measurements by gradual concepts.
b Benefit to be gained from the expertise of operators when controlling a proces.s
The fuzzy logic function is characterised by:
b 5 physical measurements used as inputs (temperature, pressure, speed).
b 20 graphic related functions which allow the physical measurement inputs to be
represented by predefined associated linguistic terms. A temperature will be
represented for example by the terms: low, average, high according to the limits for the
various terminals.
b 25 linguistic rules which determine the state to be applied to the outputs
(3 conditions and 2 conclusions per rule).
b 4 numerical variables as outputs, results applying to the function input values
b The possibility of debugging its control offline.
Once inserted in a program, the fuzzy function can either operate in continuous mode
(function executed on each scan) or on request (a single iteration on each
execution). The operating mode enables the function to be used in automatic mode
(calculation of the outputs depending on the state of the inputs) or in manual mode
(applications with predefined output values).
Software setup
The fuzzy logic function software is set up in 2 steps:
b Integration of the fuzzy function in the application program, in the same way as any
other standard function.
b Setting the fuzzy function parameters using the setup screen.
Integration in the program
The fuzzy logic function is inserted in the program in all the available languages.
The software checks the various function parameters:
b The 5 input variables.
b The 4 output variables (plus an error bit).
b The internal variables necessary for the function to operate correctly.
The function setup screen is used to access parameters (I/O), membership
functions, linguistic rules, as well as debug functions.
Membership functions
The membership functions are described intuitively using a suitable layout.
A membership function is characterised by:
b The selection of one of the parameters (I/O).
b The choice of associated linguistic terms from a library of terms predefined or
created by the user.
b The type of function to apply for the inputs (trapeze, triangle, etc) as well as its
characteristic values and the functions to apply for the outputs (singleton).
Reference:
page 5/27
5/26
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Setup (continued),
reference
It can also:
b Force the inputs for testing precise operating points.
b Change to manual mode to apply predetermined values on the outputs.
b Change the operating mode: on request, or continuously by defining a period of
activation.
Reference
This software extension enables standard functions offered by PL7 Micro, PL7 Junior
and PL7 Pro software to be extended into the domain of fuzzy logic.
It comprises:
b A set of 3"1/2 disks.
b A multilingual user manual (English, French and German).
Software for fuzzy logic processing
Description
PL7 FUZ
software
extension
Presentation:
page 5/26
Function
Development and
debugging of fuzzy
logic applications.
Defines the
membership
functions and fuzzy
rules for the
applications.
Target PLC
Reference
Weight
extension
kg
PL7 Micro/Junior/Pro TLX L PL7 FUZ 34M
0.560
TSX Micro/Premium
Setup:
page 5/26
5/27
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Presentation,
description,
functions
Presentation
The FTX 117 Adjust pocket terminal is used for adjusting Nano/Micro/Premium
PLCs. It is used to:
b Read, modify and force valid parameters.
b Save and retrieve PLC object lists.
b Up/down load programs and PLC data (one program and up to 10 data files per
protected RAM memory PCMCIA card).
The PLC provides the power supply to the FTX 117 Adjust terminal.
Description
The front panel of the FTX 117 Adjust terminal comprises:
5 Magnets on the rear of the terminal which are used to keep it in a vertical position
on a metal support.
6 A carrying strap.
6
Functions
All functions can be easily accessed at any moment using 7 editors with the following
menus:
b TSX: has menus for:
v displaying the type of PLC,
v modifying/displaying the PLC operating mode: RUN/STOP/ERR,
v naming the application and the presence of forced bits,
v module diagnostics,
v setting the internal clock of the PLC.
b DAT: data editor used to:
v access all variables in real-time display,
v modify or force valid variables,
v access to the modification and display of Grafcet steps,
v convert word objects into Hexadecimal, ASCII, decimal or binary code.
b DT-i: object list editor used to:
v display or modify a list of 16 variables,
v store and retrieve an object list (63 lists maximum),
v This function requires a PCMCIA card.
b Frc: editor to find forced bits is used to:
v find and display forced bits in the PLC.
b FTX: terminal editor is used to:
v show the terminal versio,
v select the language (English, French, German, Italian Spanish),
v adjust a beep sound and lighting.
b Adr: connection editor used to access PLCs connected to the UNI-Telway bus
(master or slave).
b Trf: transfer editor requiring a PCMCIA RAM memory card. Used for transfers from
PLCs to the PCMCIA card and vice versa, a program and one or more %MWi data
files (up to 10 data files) via the FTX 117 terminal.
TSX 0720-10
RUN ERR I/O
APP : Exec f
Mod0=OK
Example of TSX editor
%IW0.0
%IW0.0
%IW0.1
%IW0.0
0
0
200
0
Transfer list
Format Card
ADJ (max 62) :
Example of DT-i editor
%Q00
1f
End of list
References:
page 5/29
Encombrements:
page 5/29
5/28
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Function (continued),
references,
dimensions
Functions (continued)
Objects which can be accessed by the terminal
Language
element
Inputs
Outputs
Type
Symbol
Action (1)
Input bit
%Ix.i
R, W, F
%IWi, %IDi
(2)
%Qx.i
R, W
Output bit
Output word (single, double)
Internal variables
Internal bit
%QWi, %QDi R, W
(2)
%Mi
R, W, F (3)
Grafcet objects
Functions blocks
R, W, F
%Si, %SWi,
%SDi
Internal word (single, double, floating point) %MWi, %MDi
(2), %MFi (2)
Constant word (single, double, floating
%KWi, %KDi
point)
(2), %KFi (2)
Network common word
%NW{i}k (2)
R, W (4)
Step state
%Xi
R, W (2)
%Xi, T (2)
R, W
R
R, W
Indirect
access
%TMi.z,
R,
%Mi.z, %Ri.z, W (dep. on
%Ci.z,
object)
%DRi.z
Use
Reference
References
Description
Description
Weight
kg
T FTX 117 ADJ 02
0.380
Portable mini
terminal
(5)
Protected RAM
memory type 1
PCMCIA cards
0.060
Battery
0.010
0.060
Dimensions
T FTX 117 ADJ 02
95
185
30
T FTX RSMpp16
25
80
Presentation:
page 5/28
Description:
page 5/28
5/29
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection guide
Applications
Type of unit
Display units
Type
Capacity
2 lines of 20 characters or
1 to 4 lines of 5 to 20
characters
2 lines of 20 characters
4 to 8 lines of 20 to 40
characters
Display only
or
via keypad with 4 function keys + 1 service key
or
5 service keys
Application
512 Kb Flash
4050
Alphanumeric
Recipes
Curves
Alarm logs
Real-time clock
Alarm relay
Depending on model
Access to the PLC real-time clock
No
Display
Data entry
5
Memory capacity
Functions
Communication
50
Alphanumeric, bargraph, gauge
Development software
XBT L1001 and XBT L1003 (under Windows 98, 2000 and XP)
Operating systems
Magelis
Type of terminal
XBT N
Pages
(1) Depending on model
XBT H
XBT HM
5/30
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Terminals
2 lines of 20 characters
2 or 4 lines of 40 characters
4 to 8 lines of 20 to 40 characters
50
Alphanumeric
Depending on model
Access to the PLC real-time clock
No
Built-in
Yes
XBT L1001 and XBT L1003 (under Windows 98, 2000 and XP)
Magelis
XBT P
XBT E
XBT PM
5/31
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Selection guide
Applications
Type of unit
Graphic terminals
Display
Type
Capacity
5.7"
Data entry
5
Memory capacity
Functions
Communication
Application
Extension
50 to 720 application, alarm, help and print-out form pages depending on the memory card used
(512 alarms maximum)
64
Alphanumeric, bitmap, bargraph, gauge, potentiometer, selector
Recipes
Curves
Alarm logs
Real-time clock
Alarm relay
Modbus Plus, Fipio/Fipway with add-on PCMCIA type III card, Ethernet 10/100 TCP/IP
(1) (2)
Printer link
Development software
Operating systems
Magelis
Type of terminal
XBT F01/F03/FC
Pages
5/32
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Graphic stations
10.4" (colour)
48 Mb 1 (1)
30 to 480 application, alarm, help and print-out form pages depending on Limited by the internal Flash memory capacity or
the memory card used
"Compact Flash" card memory capacity
(512 alarms maximum)
XBT F02/F03/FC
Unrestricted
Alphanumeric, bitmap, bargraph, gauge, button,
light, clock, flashing light, keypad
128
Alphanumeric, bitmap, bargraph,
gauge, potentiometer, selector
32
Built-in
Yes
XBT G
TXBT F
5/33
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
6/0
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Contents
6 - Services
6 - Services
b Documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 6/2
b Power consumption of TSX Micro PLC modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 6/4
b Standards, certifications and environment conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 6/6
b Automation product certifications and community regulations . . . . . . . . page 6/8
b Schneider Electric worldwide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 6/10
b Product references index. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 6/16
6/1
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References
Documentation
Composition
Reference
(1)
Includes all documentation for TSX CD D MTE 13E
PLCs, software, networks,
buses and terminals
Weight
kg
0.120
Reference
(1)
TSX DM 37 50E
Weight
kg
0.660
TSX DM 57 43E
0.740
TLX DM 07 117E
0.265
TLX DM 07 DSE
0.320
PL7 software
Description
To be ordered separately
Reference
(1)
TLX DOC PL7 44E
Weight
kg
3.410
Reference
(1)
TMX DM M17 W V6E
Weight
kg
0.340
Terminals
Description
Designing CCX 17
applications under
Windows
(1) For documentation in french, german, spanish, etc., please consult your Regional Sales
Office.
6/2
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
References (continued)
Documentation
Reference
(1)
TSX DR NET E
Weight
kg
0.320
X-Way communication
reference manual
To be ordered separately
TSX DG KBL E
0.160
Fipway network
installation and setup
To be ordered separately
TSX DG FPW E
0.140
Fipio bus
reference manual
To be ordered separately
TSX DR FIP E
0.230
To be ordered separately
0.110
To be ordered separately
0,140
Uni-Telway bus
installation and setup
To be ordered separately
TSX DG UTW E
0.060
6
Modbus bus
user manual
To be ordered separately
TSX DG MDB E
0.040
(1) For documentation in french, german, spanish, etc., please consult your Regional Sales
Office.
6/3
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
The power supplies incorporated into TSX Micro PLC bases have sufficient nominal power to enable them to activate 60% of discrete inputs
and/or outputs simultaneously at state 1. At peak power, these power supplies can activate 100% of discrete inputs and/or outputs
simultaneously at state 1 without tripping.
Note:
b Base supplied in a.c., c 24 V process power supply must be used for the mini extension rack when this supports analogue I/O modules and
relay output modules.
b Base supplied in d.c., providing c 24 V voltage for the mini extension rack, even if this supports analogue I/O modules and relay output
modules.
For configurations near the limit, it is however necessary to establish the power consumption using the table below.
Reference
Format
Number
1/2 : half
S : standard
Voltage c 24 V (2)
Module
Total
Discrete inputs
TSX DEZ 12D2K
TSX DEZ 32D2
TSX DEZ 12D2
positive logic inputs
negative logic inputs
TSX DEZ 08A4
TSX DEZ 08A5
1/2
S
1/2
20
60
20
1/2
1/2
20
20
1/2
1/2
S
1/2
1/2
S
46/56
46/56
106/146
30
25
50
1/2
S
S
S
46/56
56/68
56/68
45
76/104
170/254
87/123
83/107
Discrete outputs
35/38
35/38
72/94
32/36
55/85
115/175
125/175
Discrete I/O
85/125
106/160
95/131
S
S
40
110/152
1/2
20
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
30
30
40
30
30
30
TSX CTZ 1A
TSX CTZ 1B
TSX CTZ 2A
TSX CTZ 2AA
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
100
100
100
120
55/76
104/132
104/132
85/125
147/197
Analogue I/O
60
60
85
90
150
180
Counting/positioning
15
15
15
15
(1) The first value corresponds to the module consumption with 60% of inputs and/or outputs at state 1 simultaneously. The second value is for 100% of inputs and/
or outputs at state 1.
(2) c 24 V sensor voltage, provided by the a 100240 V power supply on basic configurations, is limited to supplying approx. 100 inputs. In excess of this, use
a process power supply (see page 2/61).
6/4
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Reference
Format
Number
1/2 : half
S : standard
Voltage c 24 V (2)
Module
Total
Report
Communication
TSX CPP 110
TSX ETZ 410/510
TSX STZ 10
TSX SAZ 10 (3)
TSX SCP 111
TSX SCP 112
TSX SCP 114
TSX FPP 10/20
TSX MBP 100
TSX P ACC 01
(4)
1/2
1/2
60
130
100
140
120
150
330
220
150
310
150
Terminals
Consumption by
voltage
a power supplies
Nominal current
Peak current
2800
3200
500
600
400
600
c power supplies
Nominal current
Peak current
2800
3200
(1) The first value corresponds to the module consumption with 60% of inputs and/or outputs at state 1 simultaneously. The second value is for 100% of inputs and/
or outputs at state 1.
(2) c 24 V sensor voltage, provided by the a 100240 V power supply on basic configurations, is limited to supplying approx. 100 inputs. In excess of this, use
a process power supply (see page 2/61).
(3) (Consumption on c 30 V of the power supply for the AS-i bus : 50 mA typical (100 mA max).
(4) External module to be supplied with c 24 V: 100 mA typical (200 mA max).
6/5
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Standards and
certifications
Characteristics
Service conditions and recommendations relating to environment
Temperature
Operation
C
0...+ 60 (to IEC 61131-2, + 5...+ 55)
0...+ 70 with TSX FAN fan modules
Storage
C
-25...+ 70 (according to IEC 61131-2)
Relative humidity
Operation
%
1095 without condensation
Storage
%
595 without condensation (according to IEC 61131-2)
Altitude
m
02000
Supply voltage
TSX 37 10/21/22 1pp
TSX 37 05/08/10/21/22 0pp
Nominal voltage
V
c 24
a 100...240
Limit voltages
c 19..30
a 90...264
Nominal frequencies
Hz
50/60
Limit frequencies
Hz
47/63
TSX Micro PLCs themselves offer protection to IP 20 level (1). They can therefore
be installed without an envelope in reserved-access areas which do not exceed
pollution level 2 (control room with no dust-producing machine or activity). The
pollution level 2 does not take account of more severe environmental conditions: air
pollution by dust, smoke, corrosive or radioactive particles, vapours or salts, attack
by fungi, insects, ...
Environment tests
Name of test
Standards
Levels
IEC/EN 61131-2
IEC/EN 61131-2
IEC/EN 61131-2
IEC/EN 61131-2
IEC/EN 61131-2
6/6
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Environment tests
Standards
Levels
IEC 61000-4-12
IEC 61000-4-4
Surge
IEC 61000-4-5
Electrostatic discharges
Radiated electromagnetic field
IEC 61000-4-2
IEC 61000-4-3
IEC 61000-6-4
Interference field
IEC 61000-6-4
Class A
150 kHz...500 kHz quasi-peak 79 dB (V); average 66 dB (V)
500 kHz...30 MHz quasi-peak 73 dB (V); average 60 dB (V)
Class A, 10 m measurement
30 MHz...230 MHz quasi-peak 40 dB (V); 230 MHz...1 GHz quasi-peak 47 dB (V)
IEC 60068-2-2 Bd
IEC 60068-2-1 Ad
IEC 60068-2-3 Ca
IEC 60068-2-3 Db
IEC 60068-2-14 Nb
Temperature Rise
IEC 60068-2-2 Bb
IEC 60068-2-1 Ab
IEC 60068-2-30 dB
70 C for 96 hours
-25 C for 96 hours
60 C-25 C with 93...95 % relative humidity;
2 cycles: 12 hours/12 hours
- 25 C...70 C; 2 cycles: 3 hours/3 hours
IEC 60068-2-6 Fc
IEC 60068-2-6 Fc
IEC 60068-2-27 Ea
3 Hz...100 Hz/1 mm amplitude/0.7 g; endurance: fr/90 min/axis (application coefficient < 10)
10...150 Hz/150 m amplitude/2 g; endurance: 10 cycles of 1 octave/min
15 g-11 ms; 3 shocks/direction/axis
IEC 60068-2-32 Ed
IEC 60068-2-31 Ec
IEC 60068-2-32 method 1
10 cm/2 falls
30 or 10 cm/2 falls
1 m/5 falls
6/7
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Certification body
Canadian Standards Association
Australian Communication Authority
Institut de recherche Scientifique Gost Standardt
Underwriters Laboratories
Classification authority
American Bureau of Shipping
Bureau Veritas
Det Norske Veritas
Germanischer Lloyd
Lloyd's Register
Registro Italiano Navale
Register of Shipping
Country
Canada
Australia
C.I.S., Russia
USA
Country
USA
France
Norway
Germany
United-Kingdom
Italiy
C.I.S.
The table below shows the situation as of the 01.05.2002 for certifications obtained
or pending from organizations for base PLCs. An overview of certificates for
Telemecanique products is available on our Internet web site :
www.telemecanique.com
Product certifications
Certifications
C-Tick
Certified
Pending
certification
Advantys STB
CCX 17
Lexium MHD/BPH
Magelis iPC
Magelis XBT-F/FC
Magelis XBT-G/H/P/E/HM/PM
Momentum
Nano
Premium
Quantum
TBX
Telefast 2
TSX Micro
TSX/PMX 47 107
Twido
Twin Line
UL
CSA
ACA
SIMTARS
GOST
USA
Canada
Australia
Australia
CEI, Russia
Hazardous
locations
Class 1, div 2
(1)
US
(1)
(1) Hazardous locations: CSA 22.2 no. 213, certified products are suitable for use in Class I,
division 2, groups A, B, C and D or non-hazardous locations only.
(2) cULus north-american certification (Canada and US).
Specific certifications
BG
Germany
AS-Interface Europe
6/8
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Certified
Pending
certification
ABS
BV
DNV
GL
LR
USA
France
Norway
Germany
Unit.-Kingdom Italiy
RINA
RMRS
C.I.S.
Advantys STB
CCX 17
Lexium MHD/BPH
Magelis iPC
Magelis XBT-F/FC
Magelis XBT-H/P/E/HM/PM
Momentum
Nano
Premium
Quantum
TBX
Telefast 2
TSX Micro
TSX/PMX 47 107
Twido
Twin Line
Community regulations
European directives
The opening of European markets implies a harmonization of regulations in the
various European Union member states.
European Directives are documents used to remove obstacles to the free movement
of goods and their application is compulsory in all states of the European Union.
Member states are obliged to transcribe each Directive into their national legislation
and, at the same time, to withdraw any conflicting regulations.
The Directives, particularly those of a technical nature with which we are concerned,
only set objectives, called general requirements.
The manufacturer must take all necessary measures to ensure that his products
conform to the requirements of each Directive relating to his equipment.
As a general rule, the manufacturer affirms that his product conforms to the
necessary requirements of the Directive(s) by applying the e label to his product.
e marking is applied to Telemecanique products where relevant.
6/9
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Up-dated: 28-07-2003
Afghanistan
Albania
Algeria
b Schneider Electric
Andorra
Angola
Anguilla
Antartica
Argentina
b Schneider Argentina
Armenia
Aruba
Australia
Austria
Tel. : +213 21 92 97 02 09
Fax : +213 21 92 97 00 01
www.schneider-electric.com.ar
www.schneider.com.au
www.schneider-electric.at
www.squared.com
Azerbaijan
Bahamas
b Schneider Electric
Union Village
PO Box 3901 - Nassau
Bahrain
b Schneider Electric
Bangladesh
Barbados
Belarus
Belgium
Dieweg 3
B - 1180 Brussels
Tel.: +3223737711
Fax: +3223753858
www.schneider-electric.be
Belize
Benin
Bermuda
Bhutan
Bolivia
Botswana
Bouvet island
Brazil
Tel.: +55 55 24 52 33
Fax: +55 55 22 51 34
www.schneider-electric.com.br
www.schneiderelectric.bg
Brunei (Darussalam)
Bulgaria
b Schneider Electric
Burkina Faso
Burundi
Cambodia
Cameroon
Canada
b Schneider Canada
Cape Verde
Caribee
Cayman islands
Chad
Chile
Avda. Pdte Ed. Frei Montalva, 6001-31 Tel.: +56 2 444 3000
Conchali - Santiago
Fax: +56 2 423 9335
www.schneider-electric.co.cl
China
b Schneider Beijing
www.schneider-electric.com.cn
Tel.: +86 10 65 90 69 07
Fax: +86 10 65 90 00 13
www.schneider-electric.ca
6/10
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Up-dated: 28-07-2003
Christmas island
Colombia
S.A.
Comoros
Congo
Cook islands
Costa Rica
Croatia
b Schneider Electric SA
Fallerovo Setaliste 22
HR - 10000 Zagreb
Cuba
b Schneider Electric
Cyprus
Czech Republic
Thmova 13
Praha 8 - 186 00
www.schneider-electric.cz
Tel.: +45 44 73 78 88
Fax: +45 44 68 5255
www.schneider-electric.dk
Denmark
Baltorpbakken 14
DK-2750 Ballerup
Djibouti
Dominican Republic
b Schneider Electric
Ecuador
Egypt
El Salvador
Equatorial Guinea
www.schneider-ca.com
Tel.: +20 24 01 01 19
Fax: +20 24 01 66 87
www.schneider.com.eg
Eritrea
Estonia
b Lexel Electric
Ethiopia
Falkland islands
Faroe islands
Fiji
Finland
b Schneider Electric Oy
Sinimentie 14
02630 Espoo
www.schneider-electric.fi
France
b Schneider Electric SA
5, rue Nadar
92500 Rueil Malmaison
www.schneider-electric.fr
French Polynesia
Gabon
Gambia
Georgia
Germany
Gothaer Strae 29
D-40880 Ratingen
www.schneiderelectric.de
Ghana
PMB Kia
3rd Floor Opeibea House
Airport Commercial Center
Liberation road - Accra
Gilbraltar
Greece
b Schneider Electric AE
14th km - RN Athens-Lamia
GR - 14564 Kifissia
Greenland
Grenada
Guadeloupe
Guam
www.schneider-electric.com.gr
6/11
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Up-dated: 28-07-2003
Guatemala
Guinea-Bissau
Guinea
Guyana
Haiti
Honduras
Hong Kong
Tel.: +852 25 65 06 21
Fax: +852 28 11 10 29
www.schneider-electric.hu
Ltd
Hungary
Iceland
India
www.schneiderelectric-in.com
Indonesia
www.schneider-electric.co.id
b Telemecanique Iran
Irak
Tel.: +33 04 76 60 54 27
Fax: +33 04 76 60 56 60
Ireland
Maynooth Road
Cellbridge - Co. Kildare
www.schneiderelectric.ie
Italy
www.schneiderelectric.it
Ivory Coast
Tel.: +225 21 75 00 10
Fax: +225 21 75 00 30
l'Ouest
Jamaica
b Schneider Electric
Japan
Torigoe F. Bldg
1-8-2, Torigoe
Taito-Ku - 111-0054 Tokyo
Jordan
6
Kazakstan
Tel.: 962 65 16 78 87
Fax: 962 65 16 79 1
Kenya
Kiribati
Korea
Kurdistan
Kuwait
Kyrgyz Republic
Laos
Latvia
b Lexel Electric
Lebanon
Tel. : +961 1 20 46 20
Tel. : +961 1 20 31 19
Lesotho
Liberia
Libya
Liechtenstein
Lithuania
b Lexel Electric
Loro Sae
Luxembourg
www.schneider-electric.co.jp
www.csinfo.co.kr/schneider/
Tel.: 33 03 87 39 06 03
Fax: 33 03 87 74 25 96
www.schneider-electric.fr
6/12
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Up-dated: 28-07-2003
Macau
Macedonia
Madagascar
Malawi
Malaysia
Maldives
Mali
Malta
Marshall islands
Martinique
b Schneider Electric
Schneider Electric
Immeuble Cottrell - ZI de la Lzarde
97232 Le Lamentin
Mauritania
Mauritius
b Schneider Electric
Route ctire
Calodyne - Mauritius
Mayotte
Mexico
Micronesia
Moldova
Monaco
Mongolia
Montserrat
Morocco
Mozambique
Myanmar
Namibia
Nauru
Nepal
Netherlands
b Schneider Electric BV
Netherlands Antilles
New Caledonia
New Zealand
Nicaragua
Niger
Nigeria
b Schneider Electric Nigeria Limited Biro plaza - 8th Floor - Plot 634
Abeyemo Alakija Street
Victoria Islan - Lagos
www.schneiderelectric.com.my
Tel.: +05 96 51 06 00
Fax: +05 96 51 11 26
www.schneiderelectric.com.mx
www.schneider.co.ma
6
Tel.: +31 23 512 4124
Fax: +31 23 512 4100
www.schneider-electric.nl
www.schneider-electric.co.nz
Niue
Norfolk island
North Korea
Norway
Solgaard Skog 2
Postboks 128 - 1501 Moss
Oman
b Schneider Electric CA
Pakistan
Palau
Panama
Paraguay
www.schneider-electric.no
6/13
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Up-dated: 28-07-2003
Peru
Philippines
Pitcairn
Poland
www.schneider-electric.com.pe
Portugal
Av.do Forte, 3
Edificio Sucia II, Piso 3-A
CP 2028 Carnaxide
2795 Linda-A-Velha
www.schneider-electric.pl
www.schneiderelectric.pt
Puerto Rico
Qatar
Reunion
b Schneider Electric
Immeuble Futura,
190, rue des 2 canons
BP 646 - 97497 Sainte Clothilde
Tel.: +262 28 14 28
Fax: +262 28 39 37
Romania
b Schneider Electric
Bd Ficusului n42
Apimondia, Corp.A, et.1, Sector 1
Bucuresti
www.schneider-electric.ro
Russian Federation
Enisseyskaya 37
129 281 Moscow
www.schneider-electric.ru
Rwanda
Samoa
San Marino
Saudi Arabia
b Schneider Electric
Senegal
BP 15952 - Dakar-Fann
Rond point N'Gor - Dakar
Seychelles
Sierra Leone
Singapore
6
Slovak Republic
www.schneider-electric.com.sg
Borekova 10
SK-821 06 Bratislava
www.schneider-electric.sk
www.schneider-electric.si
#02-17/20 TechPoint
Singapore 569059
Slovenia
Dunasjka 47
1000 Ljubljana
Solomon islands
Somalia
South Africa
www.schneider-electric.co.za
(PTY) Ltd
Spain
www.schneiderelectric.es
Sri Lanka
Tel. : +94 77 48 54 89
www.schneiderelectric-in.com
St Helena
St Lucia
St Pierre et Miquelon
Sudan
Suriname
Swaziland
Sweden
b Schneider Electric AB
Djupdalsvgen 17/19
19129 Sollentuna
www.schneider-electric.se
Switzerland
Schermenwaldstrasse 11
CH - 3063 Ittigen
www.schneider-electric.ch
S.A.
6/14
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
Up-dated: 28-07-2003
Syrian Arab Republic
b Schneider Electric Taiwan Co Ltd 2FI., N37, Ji-Hu Road, Nei-Hu Dist., Tel. : +886 2 8751 6388
Tel. : +963 11 37 49 88 00
Fax : +963 11 37 17 55 9
Tajikistan
Thailand
Togo
Tokelau
Tonga
b Schneider Electric
Tunisia
Turkey
Ticaret A.S.
Turkmenistan
www.schneider-electric.com.tw
www.schneider-electric.co.th
www.schneiderelectric.com.tr
Tel. : +993 12 46 29 52
Fax : +993 12 46 29 52
Tuvalu
Uganda
Ukraine
b Schneider Electric
Rue Krechtchalik 2
252601 Kiev
PO Box 29580
Office Floor 2/Lulu Street
Al Marina Plaza Tower
Abu Dhabi
United Kingdom
www.schneider.co.uk
United States
b Schneider Electric
www.squared.com
Uruguay
Uzbekistan
Vanuatu
Venezuela
Viet Nam
Virgin islands
Western Sahara
Yemen
Yugoslavia
d.o.o.
Zambia
b Schneider Zambia
Zambia Office
c/o Matipi Craft Center Building
Plot 1036 - Accra Road
PO Box 22792 - Kitwe
Zimbabwe
b Schneider Electric
www.schneider-electric.com.ua
www.schneider-electric.com.ve
6/15
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
09
043 509 383
170 MCI 020 10
170 MCI 020 36
170 MCI 020 80
170 MCI 021 20
170 PNT 110 20
170 XTS 020 00
170 XTS 021 00
174 CEV 200 30
174 CEV 300 20
490 NAA 271 01
490 NAA 271 02
490 NAA 271 03
490 NAA 271 04
490 NAA 271 06
490 NOC 000 05
490 NOR 000 05
490 NOT 000 05
490 NTC 000 05
490 NTC 000 15
490 NTC 000 40
490 NTC 000 80
490 NTW 000 02
490 NTW 000 05
490 NTW 000 12
490 NTW 000 40
490 NTW 000 80
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/21
4/21
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/15
and 4/21
4/15
and 4/21
4/15
and 4/21
4/15
and 4/21
4/15
and 4/21
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/21
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
3/9,
3/19 and 3/24
ABE 7CPA11
3/24
ABE 7H08R10
3/19
ABE 7H16R20
3/19
ABE 7TES160
2/14
ABE 7ACC01
2/41
ABE 7ACC02
2/41
ABE 7ACC10
2/41
ABE 7ACC11
2/41
ABE 7ACC12
2/39
ABE 7ACC20
2/41
ABE 7ACC21
2/41
ABE 7ACC30
2/41
ABE 7ACC80
2/41
ABE 7ACC81
2/41
ABE 7ACC82
2/41
ABE 7ACC83
2/41
ABE 7ACC84
2/41
ABE 7ACC85
2/41
ABE 7BV10
2/41
ABE 7BV10E
ABE 7BV20
ABE 7BV20E
ABE 7CPA01
ABE 7CPA02
ABE 7CPA03
ABE 7CPA11
ABE 7CPA12
ABE 7CPA13
ABE 7CPA21
ABE 7CPA31
ABE 7CPA31E
ABE 7FU012
ABE 7FU050
ABE 7FU100
ABE 7FU200
ABE 7FU400
ABE 7FU630
ABE 7H08R10
ABE 7H08R11
ABE 7H08R21
ABE 7H08S21
ABE 7H12R10
ABE 7H12R11
ABE 7H12R20
ABE 7H12R21
ABE 7H12R50
ABE 7H12S21
ABE 7H16C10
ABE 7H16C11
ABE 7H16C21
ABE 7H16C31
ABE 7H16CM11
ABE 7H16CM21
ABE 7H16F43
ABE 7H16R10
ABE 7H16R11
ABE 7H16R11E
ABE 7H16R20
ABE 7H16R21
ABE 7H16R21E
ABE 7H16R23
ABE 7H16R30
ABE 7H16R31
ABE 7H16R50
ABE 7H16R50E
ABE 7H16S21
ABE 7H16S21E
ABE 7H16S43
ABE 7H20E100
ABE 7H20E200
ABE 7H20E300
ABE 7H32E150
ABE 7H32E300
ABE 7LOGF25
ABE 7LOGV10
ABE 7P08T330
ABE 7P08T330E
ABE 7P16F310
ABE 7P16F310E
ABE 7P16F312
ABE 7P16M111
ABE 7P16T111
ABE 7P16T210
ABE 7P16T212
ABE 7P16T214
ABE 7P16T215
ABE 7P16T230
ABE 7P16T230E
ABE 7P16T318
ABE 7P16T318E
ABE 7P16T330
ABE 7P16T330E
ABE 7P16T332
ABE 7P16T334
2/41
2/41
2/41
2/40
2/40
2/40
2/40
2/40
2/40
2/40
2/40
2/40
2/41
2/41
2/41
2/41
2/41
2/41
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/34
2/34
2/34
2/34
2/34
2/34
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/35
2/34
2/34
2/34
2/34
2/34
2/41
2/41
2/38
2/38
2/37
2/37
2/37
2/38
2/38
2/38
2/38
2/38
2/38
2/38
2/38
2/38
2/38
2/38
2/38
2/38
2/38
ABE 7R08S111
ABE 7R08S111E
ABE 7R08S210
ABE 7R08S210E
ABE 7R08S216
ABE 7R08S216E
ABE 7R16M111
ABE 7R16S111
ABE 7R16S111E
ABE 7R16S210
ABE 7R16S210E
ABE 7R16S212
ABE 7R16S212E
ABE 7R16T111
ABE 7R16T210
ABE 7R16T212
ABE 7R16T230
ABE 7R16T231
ABE 7R16T330
ABE 7R16T332
ABE 7R16T370
ABE 7S08S2B0
ABE 7S08S2B0E
ABE 7S08S2B1
ABE 7S08S2B1E
ABE 7S16E2B1
ABE 7S16E2B1E
ABE 7S16E2E0
ABE 7S16E2E0E
ABE 7S16E2E1
ABE 7S16E2E1E
ABE 7S16E2F0
ABE 7S16E2F0E
ABE 7S16E2M0
ABE 7S16E2M0E
ABE 7S16S1B2
ABE 7S16S1B2E
ABE 7S16S2B0
ABE 7S16S2B0E
ABE 7TES160
ABF C08R02B
ABF C08R02R
ABF C08R02W
ABF C08R12B
ABF C08R12R
ABF C08R12W
ABL 7CEM24003
ABL 7CEM24006
ABL 7CEM24012
ABL 7RE2402
ABL 7RE2403
ABL 7RE2405
ABL 7RE2410
ABL 7REQ24050
ABL 7REQ24100
ABL 7RP1205
ABL 7RP2403
ABL 7RP2405
ABL 7RP2410
ABL 7RP4803
ABL 7UEQ24100
ABL 7UEQ24200
ABL 7UES24050
ABL 7UPS24100
ABL 7UPS24200
ABL 7UPS24400
ABR 7S11
ABR 7S21
ABR 7S23
ABR 7S3
ABR 7S33
ABR 7S33E
ABS 7EA3E5
ABS 7EA3F5
ABS 7EA3M5
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/37
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/37
2/37
2/37
2/37
2/37
2/37
2/37
2/37
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/36
2/41
2/41
2/41
2/41
2/41
2/41
2/41
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/61
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
ABS 7EC3AL
ABS 7EC3B2
ABS 7EC3E2
ABS 7SA2M
ABS 7SA3MA
ABS 7SC1B
ABS 7SC2E
ABS 7SC3BA
ABS 7SC3E
AR1 SB3
AS MBKT 185
ASI ABLB3002
ASI ABLB3004
ASI ABLD3002
ASI ABLD3004
ASI ABLM3024
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/39
2/41
4/37
4/33
4/33
4/33
4/33
4/33
O
OZD FIP G3
4/55
S
SYS SPU
LFF CD28M
SYS SPU
LFG CD28M
SYS SPU
LFT CD28M
SYS SPU
LFU CD28M
SYS SPU
LRU CD28M
SYS SPU
LUF CD28M
SYS SPU
LUG CD28M
SYS SPU
LUT CD28M
T
T CCX 1720 L
T CCX 1720 LPS
T CCX 1720 LW
T CCX 1730 L
T CCX 1730 LPS
T CCX 1730 LW
T CCX CB9 030
T FTX 117 ADJ 02
T FTX CB1 020
T FTX CB1 050
T FTX RSM 12816
T FTX RSM 3216
TLX CD
PL7 DIF 41
TLX CD
PL7J p44M
TLX CD
PL7M p44M
TLX CD PL7M
PC44M
TLX CD
PL7P p44M
TLX CD3
PL7 DIF 41
TLX CD3
PL7J p44M
TLX CD3
PL7M p44M
TLX CD3
PL7P p44M
TLX DOC PL7
44F
TLX L PL7
FUZ 34M
TLX L SDKC
PL7 41M
TLX LC SMC
PL7 40M
4/25
4/25
4/25
4/25
4/25
4/25
4/25
4/25
3/13
3/13
3/13
3/13
3/13
3/13
3/13
5/29
4/66
4/66
5/29
5/29
5/23
5/18
5/18
5/18
5/19
5/23
5/18
5/18
5/19
5/19
3/27
5/25
5/21
TLX OS
PL7P P44M
TLX OT
PL7M P44M
TLX OT
PL7P P44M
TLX RCD
PL7J P44M
TLX RCD
PL7M P44M
TLX RCD
PL7M PC44M
TLX RCD
PL7P P44M
TLX RCD3
PL7J P44M
TLX RCD3
PL7M P44M
TLX RCD3
PL7P P44M
TLX S PL7P
P44M
TLX UCD
PL7J P44M
TLX UCD
PL7P P44M
TLX UCD3
PL7J P44M
TLX UCD3
PL7P P44M
TSX 07 30 1002
TSX 07 30 1008
TSX 07 30 1012
TSX 07 30 1022
TSX 07 30 1028
TSX 07 31 1602
TSX 07 31 1608
TSX 07 31 1612
TSX 07 31 1622
TSX 07 31 1628
TSX 07 31 1648
TSX 07 31 2402
TSX 07 31 2408
TSX 07 31 2412
TSX 07 31 2422
TSX 07 31 2428
TSX 07 EX 1612
TSX 07 EX 1628
TSX 07 EX 2412
TSX 07 EX 2428
TSX 37 05
028DR1
TSX 37 08
056DR1
TSX 37 10
028AR1
TSX 37 10
028DR1
TSX 37 10
128DR1
TSX 37 10
128DT1
TSX 37 10
128DTK1
TSX 37 10
164DTK1
TSX 37 21 001
TSX 37 21 101
TSX 37 22 001
TSX 37 22 101
TSX AAK2
TSX ACZ 03
TSX AEZ 414
TSX AEZ 801
TSX AEZ 802
5/19
5/19
5/19
5/18
5/18
5/18
5/19
5/18
5/18
5/19
5/19
5/18
5/19
5/18
5/18
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
2/25
1/15
1/15
1/15
1/15
1/15
1/15
1/15
1/15
1/15
1/15
1/15
1/15
3/9
3/9
3/9
3/9
3/9
6/16
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com
2/25
2/25
3/9
3/9
3/9
1/16
5/29
2/13
2/13
2/13
2/13
2/13
4/58
4/58
2/14
3/9
2/14
3/19
and 3/24
3/9
and 3/19
3/24
3/19
and 3/24
3/9
and 3/19
3/9
and 3/19
3/9
and 3/19
4/63
2/14
and 3/19
2/14
and 3/19
2/14
and 3/19
2/14
and 3/19
2/14
and 3/19
2/14
and 3/19
2/14
and 3/19
2/14
and 3/19
2/14
and 3/19
2/14
and 3/19
2/14
and 3/19
2/14
and 3/19
4/25
4/37
and 4/63
4/37
and 4/63
4/37
and 4/63
4/67
4/67
3/19
3/24
3/19
3/19
4/15
2/13
2/13
2/13
2/13
2/13
2/13
2/13
2/13
2/13
2/13
2/13
2/22
2/13
4/21
4/15
4/15
1/16
1/16
1/16
4/53
4/53
4/58
4/58
4/58
4/58
4/58
4/58
4/58
4/58
4/59
4/59
4/59
4/59
4/59
4/59
4/59
4/59
4/59
4/59
4/49
and 4/53
4/49
and 4/53
4/59
4/59
4/59
4/58
4/53
3/13
4/55
4/49
4/55
TSX FP CG 030
TSX FP CP100
TSX FP CP500
TSX FP JF020
TSX FPC10M
TSX FPP 10
TSX FPP 10
TSX FPP 10
TSX FPP 20
TSX FPP OZD
200
TSX MBP 100
TSX MBP CE 002
TSX MBP CE 030
TSX MBP CE 060
TSX MFP 0128P
TSX MFP 032P
TSX MFP 064P
TSX MFP 232P
TSX MFP 264P
TSX
MFP BAK 032P
TSX MRP 0128P
4/37
4/37
4/37
4/37
1/16
and 3/13
1/16
1/16
and 3/13
1/16
1/16
1/16
1/16
and 3/13
TSX MRP 032P
1/16
TSX MRP 064P
1/16
and 3/13
TSX MRP 2128P
1/16
TSX MRP 232P
1/16
TSX MRP 264P
1/16
TSX P ACC 01
4/15,
4/36, 4/63 and 4/65
TSX P CAP
1/16
TSX PCU 1031
4/15
TSX PCX 1031
5/19,
4/63, 4/65, 4/66 and 4/67
TSX PCX 1130
4/67
4/36
4/15,
4/36 and 4/63
TSX SCA 64
4/36
and 4/63
TSX SCA 72
4/36
and 4/63
TSX SCP 111
4/36,
4/63 and 4/65
TSX SCP 112
4/36,
4/63 and 4/65
TSX SCP 114
4/36
4/63 and 4/65
TSX SCP CC
4/37
1030
4/65 and 4/66
TSX SCP CD
4/37
1030
TSX SCP CD
4/65
1030
and 4/66
TSX SCP CD
4/37
1100
4/65 and 4/66
TSX SCP CM
4/37
4030
and 4/66
TSX SCP CM
4/37
4530
and 4/66
TSX SCP CU
4/63
4030
and 4/66
TSX SCP CU
4/63
4530
and 4/66
TSX SCP CX
4/37,
2030
4/65 and 4/66
TSX SCP CX
4/37,
4030
4/65 and 4/66
TSX SCY 11601
4/36
TSX SCY 21601
4/36,
4/49, 4/63 and 4/65
TSX SCY CM
4/37
6030
and 4/67
TSX SCY CM
4/37
6530
TSX SCY CU
4/63,
6030
4/65 and 4/67
TSX SCY CU
4/63
6530
TSX SCY CU
4/67
6530
TSX TAP S15 05
3/19
TSX TAP S15 24
3/19
TSX MRP 032P
3/13
X
XBT Z968
XBT Z9681 4/67
XTB Z908
XTB Z968
XTB Z9681
XZ CB10201
XZ CB10501
XZ CB11001
XZ SDE1113
XZ SDE1133
XZ SDP
4/67
4/67
3/13
3/13
3/13
4/27
4/27
4/27
4/27
4/27
4/27
6/17
Courtesy of Steven Engineering, Inc. 230 Ryan Way, South San Francisco, CA 94080-6370 General Inquiries: (800) 670-4183 www.stevenengineering.com